ETH Price: $2,563.54 (-0.54%)

Transaction Decoder

Block:
21778563 at Feb-05-2025 06:40:11 AM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.0010900179 ETH $2.79
Gas Used:
641,187 Gas / 1.7 Gwei

Emitted Events:

162 TWCloneFactory.ProxyDeployed( implementation=OpenEditionERC721, proxy=OpenEditionERC721, deployer=[Sender] 0x520c599b66bdc6a9f8e5bfcbfa827595ce36b398 )
163 OpenEditionERC721.ContractURIUpdated( prevURI=, newURI=ipfs://QmTBSsDUgzkTwHKSiCXfFu1FZfq6nWXkiK8j2AKLJwVAMp/0 )
164 OpenEditionERC721.OwnerUpdated( prevOwner=0x00000000...000000000, newOwner=[Sender] 0x520c599b66bdc6a9f8e5bfcbfa827595ce36b398 )
165 OpenEditionERC721.RoleGranted( role=0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, account=[Sender] 0x520c599b66bdc6a9f8e5bfcbfa827595ce36b398, sender=[Receiver] TWCloneFactory )
166 OpenEditionERC721.RoleGranted( role=9F2DF0FED2C77648DE5860A4CC508CD0818C85B8B8A1AB4CEEEF8D981C8956A6, account=[Sender] 0x520c599b66bdc6a9f8e5bfcbfa827595ce36b398, sender=[Receiver] TWCloneFactory )
167 OpenEditionERC721.RoleGranted( role=8502233096D909BEFBDA0999BB8EA2F3A6BE3C138B9FBF003752A4C8BCE86F6C, account=[Sender] 0x520c599b66bdc6a9f8e5bfcbfa827595ce36b398, sender=[Receiver] TWCloneFactory )
168 OpenEditionERC721.RoleGranted( role=8502233096D909BEFBDA0999BB8EA2F3A6BE3C138B9FBF003752A4C8BCE86F6C, account=0x00000000...000000000, sender=[Receiver] TWCloneFactory )
169 OpenEditionERC721.DefaultRoyalty( newRoyaltyRecipient=[Sender] 0x520c599b66bdc6a9f8e5bfcbfa827595ce36b398, newRoyaltyBps=0 )
170 OpenEditionERC721.PrimarySaleRecipientUpdated( recipient=[Sender] 0x520c599b66bdc6a9f8e5bfcbfa827595ce36b398 )
171 OpenEditionERC721.Initialized( version=1 )

Account State Difference:

  Address   Before After State Difference Code
(Titan Builder)
15.726164635803739879 Eth15.726469743611790679 Eth0.0003051078080508
0x520C599b...5CE36b398
0.00731532833096304 Eth
Nonce: 3
0.00622531043096304 Eth
Nonce: 4
0.0010900179
0x76F948E5...Bf524805E
0xAdFe8f5C...5F5f36F64
0 Eth
Nonce: 0
0 Eth
Nonce: 1
From: 0 To: 497590261154554171967157090889385795345709546499246521852899056439868464073528678540934775088141066796096499

Execution Trace

TWCloneFactory.deployProxyByImplementation( _implementation=0x85611636abC5A075372634360b54c9221fC04c5D, _data=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salt=00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000014C507E ) => ( deployedProxy=0xAdFe8f5CcfC4b380f17d614F47C8c775F5f36F64 )
  • OpenEditionERC721.3d602d80( )
  • OpenEditionERC721.initialize( _defaultAdmin=0x520C599b66BDC6a9f8e5bFCBfa827595CE36b398, _name=qscsca, _symbol=dacsvs, _contractURI=ipfs://QmTBSsDUgzkTwHKSiCXfFu1FZfq6nWXkiK8j2AKLJwVAMp/0, _trustedForwarders=[], _saleRecipient=0x520C599b66BDC6a9f8e5bFCBfa827595CE36b398, _royaltyRecipient=0x520C599b66BDC6a9f8e5bFCBfa827595CE36b398, _royaltyBps=0 )
    • OpenEditionERC721.initialize( _defaultAdmin=0x520C599b66BDC6a9f8e5bFCBfa827595CE36b398, _name=qscsca, _symbol=dacsvs, _contractURI=ipfs://QmTBSsDUgzkTwHKSiCXfFu1FZfq6nWXkiK8j2AKLJwVAMp/0, _trustedForwarders=[], _saleRecipient=0x520C599b66BDC6a9f8e5bFCBfa827595CE36b398, _royaltyRecipient=0x520C599b66BDC6a9f8e5bFCBfa827595CE36b398, _royaltyBps=0 )
      File 1 of 3: TWCloneFactory
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.11;
      /// @author thirdweb
      //   $$\\     $$\\       $$\\                 $$\\                         $$\\
      //   $$ |    $$ |      \\__|                $$ |                        $$ |
      // $$$$$$\\   $$$$$$$\\  $$\\  $$$$$$\\   $$$$$$$ |$$\\  $$\\  $$\\  $$$$$$\\  $$$$$$$\\
      // \\_$$  _|  $$  __$$\\ $$ |$$  __$$\\ $$  __$$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$  __$$\\ $$  __$$\\
      //   $$ |    $$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |  \\__|$$ /  $$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$$$$$$$ |$$ |  $$ |
      //   $$ |$$\\ $$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |      $$ |  $$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$   ____|$$ |  $$ |
      //   \\$$$$  |$$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |      \\$$$$$$$ |\\$$$$$\\$$$$  |\\$$$$$$$\\ $$$$$$$  |
      //    \\____/ \\__|  \\__|\\__|\\__|       \\_______| \\_____\\____/  \\_______|\\_______/
      import "./extension/interface/IContractFactory.sol";
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts/metatx/ERC2771Context.sol";
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Multicall.sol";
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts/proxy/Clones.sol";
      contract TWCloneFactory is Multicall, ERC2771Context, IContractFactory {
          /// @dev Emitted when a proxy is deployed.
          event ProxyDeployed(address indexed implementation, address proxy, address indexed deployer);
          constructor(address _trustedForwarder) ERC2771Context(_trustedForwarder) {}
          /// @dev Deploys a proxy that points to the given implementation.
          function deployProxyByImplementation(
              address _implementation,
              bytes memory _data,
              bytes32 _salt
          ) public override returns (address deployedProxy) {
              bytes32 salthash = keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_msgSender(), _salt));
              deployedProxy = Clones.cloneDeterministic(_implementation, salthash);
              emit ProxyDeployed(_implementation, deployedProxy, _msgSender());
              if (_data.length > 0) {
                  // slither-disable-next-line unused-return
                  Address.functionCall(deployedProxy, _data);
              }
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual override returns (address sender) {
              return ERC2771Context._msgSender();
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual override returns (bytes calldata) {
              return ERC2771Context._msgData();
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      interface IContractFactory {
          /**
           *  @notice Deploys a proxy that points to that points to the given implementation.
           *
           *  @param implementation           Address of the implementation to point to.
           *
           *  @param data                     Additional data to pass to the proxy constructor or any other data useful during deployement.
           *  @param salt                     Salt to use for the deterministic address generation.
           */
          function deployProxyByImplementation(
              address implementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bytes32 salt
          ) external returns (address);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (metatx/ERC2771Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      import "../utils/Context.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Context variant with ERC2771 support.
       */
      abstract contract ERC2771Context is Context {
          /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow state-variable-immutable
          address private immutable _trustedForwarder;
          /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
          constructor(address trustedForwarder) {
              _trustedForwarder = trustedForwarder;
          }
          function isTrustedForwarder(address forwarder) public view virtual returns (bool) {
              return forwarder == _trustedForwarder;
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual override returns (address sender) {
              if (isTrustedForwarder(msg.sender)) {
                  // The assembly code is more direct than the Solidity version using `abi.decode`.
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      sender := shr(96, calldataload(sub(calldatasize(), 20)))
                  }
              } else {
                  return super._msgSender();
              }
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual override returns (bytes calldata) {
              if (isTrustedForwarder(msg.sender)) {
                  return msg.data[:msg.data.length - 20];
              } else {
                  return super._msgData();
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (proxy/Clones.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1167[EIP 1167] is a standard for
       * deploying minimal proxy contracts, also known as "clones".
       *
       * > To simply and cheaply clone contract functionality in an immutable way, this standard specifies
       * > a minimal bytecode implementation that delegates all calls to a known, fixed address.
       *
       * The library includes functions to deploy a proxy using either `create` (traditional deployment) or `create2`
       * (salted deterministic deployment). It also includes functions to predict the addresses of clones deployed using the
       * deterministic method.
       *
       * _Available since v3.4._
       */
      library Clones {
          /**
           * @dev Deploys and returns the address of a clone that mimics the behaviour of `implementation`.
           *
           * This function uses the create opcode, which should never revert.
           */
          function clone(address implementation) internal returns (address instance) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let ptr := mload(0x40)
                  mstore(ptr, 0x3d602d80600a3d3981f3363d3d373d3d3d363d73000000000000000000000000)
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x14), shl(0x60, implementation))
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x28), 0x5af43d82803e903d91602b57fd5bf30000000000000000000000000000000000)
                  instance := create(0, ptr, 0x37)
              }
              require(instance != address(0), "ERC1167: create failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Deploys and returns the address of a clone that mimics the behaviour of `implementation`.
           *
           * This function uses the create2 opcode and a `salt` to deterministically deploy
           * the clone. Using the same `implementation` and `salt` multiple time will revert, since
           * the clones cannot be deployed twice at the same address.
           */
          function cloneDeterministic(address implementation, bytes32 salt) internal returns (address instance) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let ptr := mload(0x40)
                  mstore(ptr, 0x3d602d80600a3d3981f3363d3d373d3d3d363d73000000000000000000000000)
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x14), shl(0x60, implementation))
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x28), 0x5af43d82803e903d91602b57fd5bf30000000000000000000000000000000000)
                  instance := create2(0, ptr, 0x37, salt)
              }
              require(instance != address(0), "ERC1167: create2 failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Computes the address of a clone deployed using {Clones-cloneDeterministic}.
           */
          function predictDeterministicAddress(
              address implementation,
              bytes32 salt,
              address deployer
          ) internal pure returns (address predicted) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let ptr := mload(0x40)
                  mstore(ptr, 0x3d602d80600a3d3981f3363d3d373d3d3d363d73000000000000000000000000)
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x14), shl(0x60, implementation))
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x28), 0x5af43d82803e903d91602b57fd5bf3ff00000000000000000000000000000000)
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x38), shl(0x60, deployer))
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x4c), salt)
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x6c), keccak256(ptr, 0x37))
                  predicted := keccak256(add(ptr, 0x37), 0x55)
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Computes the address of a clone deployed using {Clones-cloneDeterministic}.
           */
          function predictDeterministicAddress(address implementation, bytes32 salt)
              internal
              view
              returns (address predicted)
          {
              return predictDeterministicAddress(implementation, salt, address(this));
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
                  if (returndata.length > 0) {
                      // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                          revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                      }
                  } else {
                      revert(errorMessage);
                  }
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
       * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
       * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
       * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
       * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
       * is concerned).
       *
       * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
       */
      abstract contract Context {
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
              return msg.data;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (utils/Multicall.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./Address.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Provides a function to batch together multiple calls in a single external call.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       */
      abstract contract Multicall {
          /**
           * @dev Receives and executes a batch of function calls on this contract.
           */
          function multicall(bytes[] calldata data) external virtual returns (bytes[] memory results) {
              results = new bytes[](data.length);
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < data.length; i++) {
                  results[i] = Address.functionDelegateCall(address(this), data[i]);
              }
              return results;
          }
      }
      

      File 2 of 3: OpenEditionERC721
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
       * [EIP](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165).
       *
       * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
       * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
       *
       * For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
       */
      interface IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @title ERC20 interface
       * @dev see https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20
       */
      interface IERC20 {
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          function balanceOf(address who) external view returns (uint256);
          function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
          function transfer(address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
          function approve(address spender, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./IERC165.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard.
       *
       * A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal
       * support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants.
       *
       * _Available since v4.5._
       */
      interface IERC2981 is IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of
           * exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be payed in that same unit of exchange.
           */
          function royaltyInfo(
              uint256 tokenId,
              uint256 salePrice
          ) external view returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.11;
      import "./IERC165.sol";
      import "./IERC721.sol";
      interface IERC4906 is IERC165 {
          /// @dev This event emits when the metadata of a token is changed.
          /// So that the third-party platforms such as NFT market could
          /// timely update the images and related attributes of the NFT.
          event MetadataUpdate(uint256 _tokenId);
          /// @dev This event emits when the metadata of a range of tokens is changed.
          /// So that the third-party platforms such as NFT market could
          /// timely update the images and related attributes of the NFTs.
          event BatchMetadataUpdate(uint256 _fromTokenId, uint256 _toTokenId);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract.
       */
      interface IERC721 {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
           * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import "./IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol";
      import "./ERC721AUpgradeable.sol";
      import "./ERC721A__Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @title ERC721AQueryable.
       *
       * @dev ERC721A subclass with convenience query functions.
       */
      abstract contract ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is
          ERC721A__Initializable,
          ERC721AUpgradeable,
          IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable
      {
          function __ERC721AQueryable_init() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained();
          }
          function __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {}
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
           *
           * - `addr = address(0)`
           * - `startTimestamp = 0`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = 0`
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is burned:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
           * - `burned = true`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
           *
           * Otherwise:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
           */
          function explicitOwnershipOf(
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public view virtual override returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
              unchecked {
                  if (tokenId >= _startTokenId()) {
                      if (tokenId < _nextTokenId()) {
                          // If the `tokenId` is within bounds,
                          // scan backwards for the initialized ownership slot.
                          while (!_ownershipIsInitialized(tokenId)) --tokenId;
                          return _ownershipAt(tokenId);
                      }
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
           * in the range [`start`, `stop`)
           * (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
           *
           * This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
           * grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `start < stop`
           */
          function tokensOfOwnerIn(
              address owner,
              uint256 start,
              uint256 stop
          ) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
              return _tokensOfOwnerIn(owner, start, stop);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
           * It is meant to be called off-chain.
           *
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
           * multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
           * an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
           */
          function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
              uint256 start = _startTokenId();
              uint256 stop = _nextTokenId();
              uint256[] memory tokenIds;
              if (start != stop) tokenIds = _tokensOfOwnerIn(owner, start, stop);
              return tokenIds;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Helper function for returning an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * Note that this function is optimized for smaller bytecode size over runtime gas,
           * since it is meant to be called off-chain.
           */
          function _tokensOfOwnerIn(address owner, uint256 start, uint256 stop) private view returns (uint256[] memory) {
              unchecked {
                  if (start >= stop) _revert(InvalidQueryRange.selector);
                  // Set `start = max(start, _startTokenId())`.
                  if (start < _startTokenId()) {
                      start = _startTokenId();
                  }
                  uint256 stopLimit = _nextTokenId();
                  // Set `stop = min(stop, stopLimit)`.
                  if (stop >= stopLimit) {
                      stop = stopLimit;
                  }
                  uint256[] memory tokenIds;
                  uint256 tokenIdsMaxLength = balanceOf(owner);
                  bool startLtStop = start < stop;
                  assembly {
                      // Set `tokenIdsMaxLength` to zero if `start` is less than `stop`.
                      tokenIdsMaxLength := mul(tokenIdsMaxLength, startLtStop)
                  }
                  if (tokenIdsMaxLength != 0) {
                      // Set `tokenIdsMaxLength = min(balanceOf(owner), stop - start)`,
                      // to cater for cases where `balanceOf(owner)` is too big.
                      if (stop - start <= tokenIdsMaxLength) {
                          tokenIdsMaxLength = stop - start;
                      }
                      assembly {
                          // Grab the free memory pointer.
                          tokenIds := mload(0x40)
                          // Allocate one word for the length, and `tokenIdsMaxLength` words
                          // for the data. `shl(5, x)` is equivalent to `mul(32, x)`.
                          mstore(0x40, add(tokenIds, shl(5, add(tokenIdsMaxLength, 1))))
                      }
                      // We need to call `explicitOwnershipOf(start)`,
                      // because the slot at `start` may not be initialized.
                      TokenOwnership memory ownership = explicitOwnershipOf(start);
                      address currOwnershipAddr;
                      // If the starting slot exists (i.e. not burned),
                      // initialize `currOwnershipAddr`.
                      // `ownership.address` will not be zero,
                      // as `start` is clamped to the valid token ID range.
                      if (!ownership.burned) {
                          currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
                      }
                      uint256 tokenIdsIdx;
                      // Use a do-while, which is slightly more efficient for this case,
                      // as the array will at least contain one element.
                      do {
                          ownership = _ownershipAt(start);
                          assembly {
                              switch mload(add(ownership, 0x40))
                              // if `ownership.burned == false`.
                              case 0 {
                                  // if `ownership.addr != address(0)`.
                                  // The `addr` already has it's upper 96 bits clearned,
                                  // since it is written to memory with regular Solidity.
                                  if mload(ownership) {
                                      currOwnershipAddr := mload(ownership)
                                  }
                                  // if `currOwnershipAddr == owner`.
                                  // The `shl(96, x)` is to make the comparison agnostic to any
                                  // dirty upper 96 bits in `owner`.
                                  if iszero(shl(96, xor(currOwnershipAddr, owner))) {
                                      tokenIdsIdx := add(tokenIdsIdx, 1)
                                      mstore(add(tokenIds, shl(5, tokenIdsIdx)), start)
                                  }
                              }
                              // Otherwise, reset `currOwnershipAddr`.
                              // This handles the case of batch burned tokens
                              // (burned bit of first slot set, remaining slots left uninitialized).
                              default {
                                  currOwnershipAddr := 0
                              }
                              start := add(start, 1)
                          }
                      } while (!(start == stop || tokenIdsIdx == tokenIdsMaxLength));
                      // Store the length of the array.
                      assembly {
                          mstore(tokenIds, tokenIdsIdx)
                      }
                  }
                  return tokenIds;
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      library ERC721AStorage {
          // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
          struct TokenApprovalRef {
              address value;
          }
          struct Layout {
              // =============================================================
              //                            STORAGE
              // =============================================================
              // The next token ID to be minted.
              uint256 _currentIndex;
              // The number of tokens burned.
              uint256 _burnCounter;
              // Token name
              string _name;
              // Token symbol
              string _symbol;
              // Mapping from token ID to ownership details
              // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
              // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
              //
              // Bits Layout:
              // - [0..159]   `addr`
              // - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
              // - [224]      `burned`
              // - [225]      `nextInitialized`
              // - [232..255] `extraData`
              mapping(uint256 => uint256) _packedOwnerships;
              // Mapping owner address to address data.
              //
              // Bits Layout:
              // - [0..63]    `balance`
              // - [64..127]  `numberMinted`
              // - [128..191] `numberBurned`
              // - [192..255] `aux`
              mapping(address => uint256) _packedAddressData;
              // Mapping from token ID to approved address.
              mapping(uint256 => ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef) _tokenApprovals;
              // Mapping from owner to operator approvals
              mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) _operatorApprovals;
          }
          bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256("ERC721A.contracts.storage.ERC721A");
          function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
              bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
              assembly {
                  l.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import "./IERC721AUpgradeable.sol";
      import { ERC721AStorage } from "./ERC721AStorage.sol";
      import "./ERC721A__Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
       */
      interface ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable {
          function onERC721Received(
              address operator,
              address from,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external returns (bytes4);
      }
      /**
       * @title ERC721A
       *
       * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
       * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
       * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
       *
       * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
       * starting from `_startTokenId()`.
       *
       * Assumptions:
       *
       * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
       * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
       */
      contract ERC721AUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable {
          using ERC721AStorage for ERC721AStorage.Layout;
          // =============================================================
          //                           CONSTANTS
          // =============================================================
          // Mask of an entry in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
          // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
          // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
          // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
          // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
          // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
          // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
          // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
          // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
          // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
          // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
          // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
          // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
          // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
          // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
          // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
          uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
          // The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
          // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
          bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
              0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
          // =============================================================
          //                          CONSTRUCTOR
          // =============================================================
          function __ERC721A_init(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              __ERC721A_init_unchained(name_, symbol_);
          }
          function __ERC721A_init_unchained(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._name = name_;
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol = symbol_;
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = _startTokenId();
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                   TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the starting token ID.
           * To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
           */
          function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
           */
          function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
              // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
              unchecked {
                  return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
           */
          function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
              // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
              unchecked {
                  return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
           */
          function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                    ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              if (owner == address(0)) _revert(BalanceQueryForZeroAddress.selector);
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
           */
          function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return
                  (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
           */
          function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return
                  (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           */
          function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
              return uint64(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
          }
          /**
           * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
           */
          function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner];
              uint256 auxCasted;
              // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  auxCasted := aux
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
              // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
              // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
              // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
              return
                  interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
                  interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
                  interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._name;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) _revert(URIQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
              string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
              return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : "";
          }
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
              return "";
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                     OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
           * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
           */
          function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
           */
          function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether the ownership slot at `index` is initialized.
           * An uninitialized slot does not necessarily mean that the slot has no owner.
           */
          function _ownershipIsInitialized(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] != 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
           */
          function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
              if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
              }
          }
          /**
           * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 packed) {
              if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
                  packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId];
                  // If the data at the starting slot does not exist, start the scan.
                  if (packed == 0) {
                      if (tokenId >= ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
                      // Invariant:
                      // There will always be an initialized ownership slot
                      // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                      // before an unintialized ownership slot
                      // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                      // Hence, `tokenId` will not underflow.
                      //
                      // We can directly compare the packed value.
                      // If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
                      for (;;) {
                          unchecked {
                              packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[--tokenId];
                          }
                          if (packed == 0) continue;
                          if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) return packed;
                          // Otherwise, the token is burned, and we must revert.
                          // This handles the case of batch burned tokens, where only the burned bit
                          // of the starting slot is set, and remaining slots are left uninitialized.
                          _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
                      }
                  }
                  // Otherwise, the data exists and we can skip the scan.
                  // This is possible because we have already achieved the target condition.
                  // This saves 2143 gas on transfers of initialized tokens.
                  // If the token is not burned, return `packed`. Otherwise, revert.
                  if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) return packed;
              }
              _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
           */
          function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
              ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
              ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
              ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
              ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
           */
          function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
                  result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
           */
          function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
              // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
              assembly {
                  // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
                  result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                      APPROVAL OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. See {ERC721A-_approve}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              _approve(to, tokenId, true);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) _revert(ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
              emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
           *
           * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
           */
          function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool result) {
              if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
                  if (tokenId < ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                      uint256 packed;
                      while ((packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId]) == 0) --tokenId;
                      result = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0;
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
           */
          function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
              address approvedAddress,
              address owner,
              address msgSender
          ) private pure returns (bool result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
                  result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(
              uint256 tokenId
          ) private view returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) {
              ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId];
              // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
              assembly {
                  approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
                  approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                      TRANSFER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
              // Mask `from` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
              from = address(uint160(uint256(uint160(from)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS));
              if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) _revert(TransferFromIncorrectOwner.selector);
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
              // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
              if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) _revert(TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
                  --ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
                  ++ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the next owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
              // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
              uint256 toMasked = uint256(uint160(to)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS;
              assembly {
                  // Emit the `Transfer` event.
                  log4(
                      0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
                      0, // End of data (0, since no data).
                      _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
                      from, // `from`.
                      toMasked, // `to`.
                      tokenId // `tokenId`.
                  )
              }
              if (toMasked == 0) _revert(TransferToZeroAddress.selector);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, "");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) public payable virtual override {
              transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
              if (to.code.length != 0)
                  if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
                      _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                  }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called before burning one token.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _beforeTokenTransfers(address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {}
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * have been transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called after one token has been burned.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _afterTokenTransfers(address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {}
          /**
           * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
           *
           * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
           * `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
           * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
           * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
           *
           * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
           */
          function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) private returns (bool) {
              try
                  ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data)
              returns (bytes4 retval) {
                  return retval == ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received.selector;
              } catch (bytes memory reason) {
                  if (reason.length == 0) {
                      _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                  }
                  assembly {
                      revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
                  }
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        MINT OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
              if (quantity == 0) _revert(MintZeroQuantity.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
              // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
              // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
              // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
                  // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  uint256 toMasked = uint256(uint160(to)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS;
                  if (toMasked == 0) _revert(MintToZeroAddress.selector);
                  uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
                  uint256 tokenId = startTokenId;
                  do {
                      assembly {
                          // Emit the `Transfer` event.
                          log4(
                              0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
                              0, // End of data (0, since no data).
                              _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
                              0, // `address(0)`.
                              toMasked, // `to`.
                              tokenId // `tokenId`.
                          )
                      }
                      // The `!=` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
                      // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
                  } while (++tokenId != end);
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = end;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
           *
           * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
           * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
           *
           * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
           * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
           * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
           * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
           */
          function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
              if (to == address(0)) _revert(MintToZeroAddress.selector);
              if (quantity == 0) _revert(MintZeroQuantity.selector);
              if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) _revert(MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
              // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
                  emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * See {_mint}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity, bytes memory _data) internal virtual {
              _mint(to, quantity);
              unchecked {
                  if (to.code.length != 0) {
                      uint256 end = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
                      uint256 index = end - quantity;
                      do {
                          if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
                              _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                          }
                      } while (index < end);
                      // Reentrancy protection.
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex != end) _revert(bytes4(0));
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
           */
          function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              _safeMint(to, quantity, "");
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                       APPROVAL OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_approve(to, tokenId, false)`.
           */
          function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _approve(to, tokenId, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
              address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
              if (approvalCheck && _msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
                      _revert(ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
                  }
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
              emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        BURN OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _burn(tokenId, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
              address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
              if (approvalCheck) {
                  // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
                  if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                      if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) _revert(TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
              }
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance -= 1`.
                  // - `numberBurned += 1`.
                  //
                  // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
                  // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the last owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
                  // - `burned` to `true`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      from,
                      (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
              emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
              // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
              unchecked {
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter++;
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                     EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
           */
          function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index];
              if (packed == 0) _revert(OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData.selector);
              uint256 extraDataCasted;
              // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  extraDataCasted := extraData
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
           * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
           *
           * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _extraData(address from, address to, uint24 previousExtraData) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
           * The returned result is shifted into position.
           */
          function _nextExtraData(address from, address to, uint256 prevOwnershipPacked) private view returns (uint256) {
              uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                       OTHER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
           *
           * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
           */
          function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
           */
          function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
              assembly {
                  // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
                  // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
                  // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
                  // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
                  let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
                  // Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
                  mstore(0x40, m)
                  // Assign the `str` to the end.
                  str := sub(m, 0x20)
                  // Zeroize the slot after the string.
                  mstore(str, 0)
                  // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
                  let end := str
                  // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
                  // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
                  // prettier-ignore
                  for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
                      str := sub(str, 1)
                      // Write the character to the pointer.
                      // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
                      mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
                      // Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
                      temp := div(temp, 10)
                      // prettier-ignore
                      if iszero(temp) { break }
                  }
                  let length := sub(end, str)
                  // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
                  str := sub(str, 0x20)
                  // Store the length.
                  mstore(str, length)
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev For more efficient reverts.
           */
          function _revert(bytes4 errorSelector) internal pure {
              assembly {
                  mstore(0x00, errorSelector)
                  revert(0x00, 0x04)
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable diamond facet contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
       * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
       * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
       * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
       *
       * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
       * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
       *
       * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
       * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
       */
      import { ERC721A__InitializableStorage } from "./ERC721A__InitializableStorage.sol";
      abstract contract ERC721A__Initializable {
          using ERC721A__InitializableStorage for ERC721A__InitializableStorage.Layout;
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice.
           */
          modifier initializerERC721A() {
              // If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple
              // inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the
              // contract may have been reentered.
              require(
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing
                      ? _isConstructor()
                      : !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized,
                  "ERC721A__Initializable: contract is already initialized"
              );
              bool isTopLevelCall = !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = true;
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized = true;
              }
              _;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = false;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
           * {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly.
           */
          modifier onlyInitializingERC721A() {
              require(
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing,
                  "ERC721A__Initializable: contract is not initializing"
              );
              _;
          }
          /// @dev Returns true if and only if the function is running in the constructor
          function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) {
              // extcodesize checks the size of the code stored in an address, and
              // address returns the current address. Since the code is still not
              // deployed when running a constructor, any checks on its code size will
              // yield zero, making it an effective way to detect if a contract is
              // under construction or not.
              address self = address(this);
              uint256 cs;
              assembly {
                  cs := extcodesize(self)
              }
              return cs == 0;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is a base storage for the  initialization function for upgradeable diamond facet contracts
       **/
      library ERC721A__InitializableStorage {
          struct Layout {
              /*
               * Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
               */
              bool _initialized;
              /*
               * Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
               */
              bool _initializing;
          }
          bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256("ERC721A.contracts.storage.initializable.facet");
          function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
              bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
              assembly {
                  l.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import "./IERC721AUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721AQueryable.
       */
      interface IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is IERC721AUpgradeable {
          /**
           * Invalid query range (`start` >= `stop`).
           */
          error InvalidQueryRange();
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
           *
           * - `addr = address(0)`
           * - `startTimestamp = 0`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = 0`
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is burned:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
           * - `burned = true`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
           *
           * Otherwise:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
           */
          function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (TokenOwnership memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
           * in the range [`start`, `stop`)
           * (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
           *
           * This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
           * grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `start < stop`
           */
          function tokensOfOwnerIn(address owner, uint256 start, uint256 stop) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
           * It is meant to be called off-chain.
           *
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
           * multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
           * an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
           */
          function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721A.
       */
      interface IERC721AUpgradeable {
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
           */
          error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
          /**
           * Cannot mint to the zero address.
           */
          error MintToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
           */
          error MintZeroQuantity();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token must be owned by `from`.
           */
          error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
          /**
           * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
           * ERC721Receiver interface.
           */
          error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
          /**
           * Cannot transfer to the zero address.
           */
          error TransferToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
           */
          error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
          /**
           * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
           */
          error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
          // =============================================================
          //                            STRUCTS
          // =============================================================
          struct TokenOwnership {
              // The address of the owner.
              address addr;
              // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
              uint64 startTimestamp;
              // Whether the token has been burned.
              bool burned;
              // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
              uint24 extraData;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                         TOKEN COUNTERS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC721
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
           * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
           * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
           * to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
           * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
           * whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
          // =============================================================
          //                           IERC2309
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
           * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
           *
           * See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
           */
          event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IContractMetadata.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Contract Metadata
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `ContractMetadata` is a contract extension for any base contracts. It lets you set a metadata URI
       *           for you contract.
       *           Additionally, `ContractMetadata` is necessary for NFT contracts that want royalties to get distributed on OpenSea.
       */
      abstract contract ContractMetadata is IContractMetadata {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error ContractMetadataUnauthorized();
          /// @notice Returns the contract metadata URI.
          string public override contractURI;
          /**
           *  @notice         Lets a contract admin set the URI for contract-level metadata.
           *  @dev            Caller should be authorized to setup contractURI, e.g. contract admin.
           *                  See {_canSetContractURI}.
           *                  Emits {ContractURIUpdated Event}.
           *
           *  @param _uri     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           */
          function setContractURI(string memory _uri) external override {
              if (!_canSetContractURI()) {
                  revert ContractMetadataUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupContractURI(_uri);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set the URI for contract-level metadata.
          function _setupContractURI(string memory _uri) internal {
              string memory prevURI = contractURI;
              contractURI = _uri;
              emit ContractURIUpdated(prevURI, _uri);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether contract metadata can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetContractURI() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IDrop.sol";
      import "../lib/MerkleProof.sol";
      abstract contract Drop is IDrop {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error DropUnauthorized();
          /// @dev Exceeded the max token total supply
          error DropExceedMaxSupply();
          /// @dev No active claim condition
          error DropNoActiveCondition();
          /// @dev Claim condition invalid currency or price
          error DropClaimInvalidTokenPrice(
              address expectedCurrency,
              uint256 expectedPricePerToken,
              address actualCurrency,
              uint256 actualExpectedPricePerToken
          );
          /// @dev Claim condition exceeded limit
          error DropClaimExceedLimit(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          /// @dev Claim condition exceeded max supply
          error DropClaimExceedMaxSupply(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          /// @dev Claim condition not started yet
          error DropClaimNotStarted(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                                  State variables
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev The active conditions for claiming tokens.
          ClaimConditionList public claimCondition;
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                                  Drop logic
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Lets an account claim tokens.
          function claim(
              address _receiver,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof,
              bytes memory _data
          ) public payable virtual override {
              _beforeClaim(_receiver, _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken, _allowlistProof, _data);
              uint256 activeConditionId = getActiveClaimConditionId();
              verifyClaim(activeConditionId, _dropMsgSender(), _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken, _allowlistProof);
              // Update contract state.
              claimCondition.conditions[activeConditionId].supplyClaimed += _quantity;
              claimCondition.supplyClaimedByWallet[activeConditionId][_dropMsgSender()] += _quantity;
              // If there's a price, collect price.
              _collectPriceOnClaim(address(0), _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken);
              // Mint the relevant tokens to claimer.
              uint256 startTokenId = _transferTokensOnClaim(_receiver, _quantity);
              emit TokensClaimed(activeConditionId, _dropMsgSender(), _receiver, startTokenId, _quantity);
              _afterClaim(_receiver, _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken, _allowlistProof, _data);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set claim conditions.
          function setClaimConditions(
              ClaimCondition[] calldata _conditions,
              bool _resetClaimEligibility
          ) external virtual override {
              if (!_canSetClaimConditions()) {
                  revert DropUnauthorized();
              }
              uint256 existingStartIndex = claimCondition.currentStartId;
              uint256 existingPhaseCount = claimCondition.count;
              /**
               *  The mapping `supplyClaimedByWallet` uses a claim condition's UID as a key.
               *
               *  If `_resetClaimEligibility == true`, we assign completely new UIDs to the claim
               *  conditions in `_conditions`, effectively resetting the restrictions on claims expressed
               *  by `supplyClaimedByWallet`.
               */
              uint256 newStartIndex = existingStartIndex;
              if (_resetClaimEligibility) {
                  newStartIndex = existingStartIndex + existingPhaseCount;
              }
              claimCondition.count = _conditions.length;
              claimCondition.currentStartId = newStartIndex;
              uint256 lastConditionStartTimestamp;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < _conditions.length; i++) {
                  require(i == 0 || lastConditionStartTimestamp < _conditions[i].startTimestamp, "ST");
                  uint256 supplyClaimedAlready = claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i].supplyClaimed;
                  if (supplyClaimedAlready > _conditions[i].maxClaimableSupply) {
                      revert DropExceedMaxSupply();
                  }
                  claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i] = _conditions[i];
                  claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i].supplyClaimed = supplyClaimedAlready;
                  lastConditionStartTimestamp = _conditions[i].startTimestamp;
              }
              /**
               *  Gas refunds (as much as possible)
               *
               *  If `_resetClaimEligibility == true`, we assign completely new UIDs to the claim
               *  conditions in `_conditions`. So, we delete claim conditions with UID < `newStartIndex`.
               *
               *  If `_resetClaimEligibility == false`, and there are more existing claim conditions
               *  than in `_conditions`, we delete the existing claim conditions that don't get replaced
               *  by the conditions in `_conditions`.
               */
              if (_resetClaimEligibility) {
                  for (uint256 i = existingStartIndex; i < newStartIndex; i++) {
                      delete claimCondition.conditions[i];
                  }
              } else {
                  if (existingPhaseCount > _conditions.length) {
                      for (uint256 i = _conditions.length; i < existingPhaseCount; i++) {
                          delete claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i];
                      }
                  }
              }
              emit ClaimConditionsUpdated(_conditions, _resetClaimEligibility);
          }
          /// @dev Checks a request to claim NFTs against the active claim condition's criteria.
          function verifyClaim(
              uint256 _conditionId,
              address _claimer,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof
          ) public view virtual returns (bool isOverride) {
              ClaimCondition memory currentClaimPhase = claimCondition.conditions[_conditionId];
              uint256 claimLimit = currentClaimPhase.quantityLimitPerWallet;
              uint256 claimPrice = currentClaimPhase.pricePerToken;
              address claimCurrency = currentClaimPhase.currency;
              /*
               * Here `isOverride` implies that if the merkle proof verification fails,
               * the claimer would claim through open claim limit instead of allowlisted limit.
               */
              if (currentClaimPhase.merkleRoot != bytes32(0)) {
                  (isOverride, ) = MerkleProof.verify(
                      _allowlistProof.proof,
                      currentClaimPhase.merkleRoot,
                      keccak256(
                          abi.encodePacked(
                              _claimer,
                              _allowlistProof.quantityLimitPerWallet,
                              _allowlistProof.pricePerToken,
                              _allowlistProof.currency
                          )
                      )
                  );
              }
              if (isOverride) {
                  claimLimit = _allowlistProof.quantityLimitPerWallet != 0
                      ? _allowlistProof.quantityLimitPerWallet
                      : claimLimit;
                  claimPrice = _allowlistProof.pricePerToken != type(uint256).max
                      ? _allowlistProof.pricePerToken
                      : claimPrice;
                  claimCurrency = _allowlistProof.pricePerToken != type(uint256).max && _allowlistProof.currency != address(0)
                      ? _allowlistProof.currency
                      : claimCurrency;
              }
              uint256 supplyClaimedByWallet = claimCondition.supplyClaimedByWallet[_conditionId][_claimer];
              if (_currency != claimCurrency || _pricePerToken != claimPrice) {
                  revert DropClaimInvalidTokenPrice(_currency, _pricePerToken, claimCurrency, claimPrice);
              }
              if (_quantity == 0 || (_quantity + supplyClaimedByWallet > claimLimit)) {
                  revert DropClaimExceedLimit(claimLimit, _quantity + supplyClaimedByWallet);
              }
              if (currentClaimPhase.supplyClaimed + _quantity > currentClaimPhase.maxClaimableSupply) {
                  revert DropClaimExceedMaxSupply(
                      currentClaimPhase.maxClaimableSupply,
                      currentClaimPhase.supplyClaimed + _quantity
                  );
              }
              if (currentClaimPhase.startTimestamp > block.timestamp) {
                  revert DropClaimNotStarted(currentClaimPhase.startTimestamp, block.timestamp);
              }
          }
          /// @dev At any given moment, returns the uid for the active claim condition.
          function getActiveClaimConditionId() public view returns (uint256) {
              for (uint256 i = claimCondition.currentStartId + claimCondition.count; i > claimCondition.currentStartId; i--) {
                  if (block.timestamp >= claimCondition.conditions[i - 1].startTimestamp) {
                      return i - 1;
                  }
              }
              revert DropNoActiveCondition();
          }
          /// @dev Returns the claim condition at the given uid.
          function getClaimConditionById(uint256 _conditionId) external view returns (ClaimCondition memory condition) {
              condition = claimCondition.conditions[_conditionId];
          }
          /// @dev Returns the supply claimed by claimer for a given conditionId.
          function getSupplyClaimedByWallet(
              uint256 _conditionId,
              address _claimer
          ) public view returns (uint256 supplyClaimedByWallet) {
              supplyClaimedByWallet = claimCondition.supplyClaimedByWallet[_conditionId][_claimer];
          }
          /*////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
              Optional hooks that can be implemented in the derived contract
          ///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Exposes the ability to override the msg sender.
          function _dropMsgSender() internal virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          /// @dev Runs before every `claim` function call.
          function _beforeClaim(
              address _receiver,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof,
              bytes memory _data
          ) internal virtual {}
          /// @dev Runs after every `claim` function call.
          function _afterClaim(
              address _receiver,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof,
              bytes memory _data
          ) internal virtual {}
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
              Virtual functions: to be implemented in derived contract
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Collects and distributes the primary sale value of NFTs being claimed.
          function _collectPriceOnClaim(
              address _primarySaleRecipient,
              uint256 _quantityToClaim,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken
          ) internal virtual;
          /// @dev Transfers the NFTs being claimed.
          function _transferTokensOnClaim(
              address _to,
              uint256 _quantityBeingClaimed
          ) internal virtual returns (uint256 startTokenId);
          /// @dev Determine what wallet can update claim conditions
          function _canSetClaimConditions() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "../lib/Address.sol";
      import "./interface/IMulticall.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Provides a function to batch together multiple calls in a single external call.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       */
      contract Multicall is IMulticall {
          /**
           *  @notice Receives and executes a batch of function calls on this contract.
           *  @dev Receives and executes a batch of function calls on this contract.
           *
           *  @param data The bytes data that makes up the batch of function calls to execute.
           *  @return results The bytes data that makes up the result of the batch of function calls executed.
           */
          function multicall(bytes[] calldata data) external returns (bytes[] memory results) {
              results = new bytes[](data.length);
              address sender = _msgSender();
              bool isForwarder = msg.sender != sender;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < data.length; i++) {
                  if (isForwarder) {
                      results[i] = Address.functionDelegateCall(address(this), abi.encodePacked(data[i], sender));
                  } else {
                      results[i] = Address.functionDelegateCall(address(this), data[i]);
                  }
              }
              return results;
          }
          /// @notice Returns the sender in the given execution context.
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IOwnable.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Ownable
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `Ownable` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *           who the 'owner' of the inheriting smart contract is, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses
       *           information about who the contract's owner is.
       */
      abstract contract Ownable is IOwnable {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error OwnableUnauthorized();
          /// @dev Owner of the contract (purpose: OpenSea compatibility)
          address private _owner;
          /// @dev Reverts if caller is not the owner.
          modifier onlyOwner() {
              if (msg.sender != _owner) {
                  revert OwnableUnauthorized();
              }
              _;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Returns the owner of the contract.
           */
          function owner() public view override returns (address) {
              return _owner;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Lets an authorized wallet set a new owner for the contract.
           *  @param _newOwner The address to set as the new owner of the contract.
           */
          function setOwner(address _newOwner) external override {
              if (!_canSetOwner()) {
                  revert OwnableUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupOwner(_newOwner);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set a new owner for the contract. The new owner must be a contract admin.
          function _setupOwner(address _newOwner) internal {
              address _prevOwner = _owner;
              _owner = _newOwner;
              emit OwnerUpdated(_prevOwner, _newOwner);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether owner can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetOwner() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IPermissions.sol";
      import "../lib/Strings.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Permissions
       *  @dev     This contracts provides extending-contracts with role-based access control mechanisms
       */
      contract Permissions is IPermissions {
          /// @dev The `account` is missing a role.
          error PermissionsUnauthorizedAccount(address account, bytes32 neededRole);
          /// @dev The `account` already is a holder of `role`
          error PermissionsAlreadyGranted(address account, bytes32 role);
          /// @dev Invalid priviledge to revoke
          error PermissionsInvalidPermission(address expected, address actual);
          /// @dev Map from keccak256 hash of a role => a map from address => whether address has role.
          mapping(bytes32 => mapping(address => bool)) private _hasRole;
          /// @dev Map from keccak256 hash of a role to role admin. See {getRoleAdmin}.
          mapping(bytes32 => bytes32) private _getRoleAdmin;
          /// @dev Default admin role for all roles. Only accounts with this role can grant/revoke other roles.
          bytes32 public constant DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE = 0x00;
          /// @dev Modifier that checks if an account has the specified role; reverts otherwise.
          modifier onlyRole(bytes32 role) {
              _checkRole(role, msg.sender);
              _;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Checks whether an account has a particular role.
           *  @dev            Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account for which the role is being checked.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) public view override returns (bool) {
              return _hasRole[role][account];
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Checks whether an account has a particular role;
           *                  role restrictions can be swtiched on and off.
           *
           *  @dev            Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           *                  Role restrictions can be swtiched on and off:
           *                      - If address(0) has ROLE, then the ROLE restrictions
           *                        don't apply.
           *                      - If address(0) does not have ROLE, then the ROLE
           *                        restrictions will apply.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account for which the role is being checked.
           */
          function hasRoleWithSwitch(bytes32 role, address account) public view returns (bool) {
              if (!_hasRole[role][address(0)]) {
                  return _hasRole[role][account];
              }
              return true;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Returns the admin role that controls the specified role.
           *  @dev            See {grantRole} and {revokeRole}.
           *                  To change a role's admin, use {_setRoleAdmin}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view override returns (bytes32) {
              return _getRoleAdmin[role];
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Grants a role to an account, if not previously granted.
           *  @dev            Caller must have admin role for the `role`.
           *                  Emits {RoleGranted Event}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account to which the role is being granted.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              _checkRole(_getRoleAdmin[role], msg.sender);
              if (_hasRole[role][account]) {
                  revert PermissionsAlreadyGranted(account, role);
              }
              _setupRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Revokes role from an account.
           *  @dev            Caller must have admin role for the `role`.
           *                  Emits {RoleRevoked Event}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account from which the role is being revoked.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              _checkRole(_getRoleAdmin[role], msg.sender);
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Revokes role from the account.
           *  @dev            Caller must have the `role`, with caller being the same as `account`.
           *                  Emits {RoleRevoked Event}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account from which the role is being revoked.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              if (msg.sender != account) {
                  revert PermissionsInvalidPermission(msg.sender, account);
              }
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /// @dev Sets `adminRole` as `role`'s admin role.
          function _setRoleAdmin(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) internal virtual {
              bytes32 previousAdminRole = _getRoleAdmin[role];
              _getRoleAdmin[role] = adminRole;
              emit RoleAdminChanged(role, previousAdminRole, adminRole);
          }
          /// @dev Sets up `role` for `account`
          function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              _hasRole[role][account] = true;
              emit RoleGranted(role, account, msg.sender);
          }
          /// @dev Revokes `role` from `account`
          function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              _checkRole(role, account);
              delete _hasRole[role][account];
              emit RoleRevoked(role, account, msg.sender);
          }
          /// @dev Checks `role` for `account`. Reverts with a message including the required role.
          function _checkRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal view virtual {
              if (!_hasRole[role][account]) {
                  revert PermissionsUnauthorizedAccount(account, role);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Checks `role` for `account`. Reverts with a message including the required role.
          function _checkRoleWithSwitch(bytes32 role, address account) internal view virtual {
              if (!hasRoleWithSwitch(role, account)) {
                  revert PermissionsUnauthorizedAccount(account, role);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IPermissionsEnumerable.sol";
      import "./Permissions.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   PermissionsEnumerable
       *  @dev     This contracts provides extending-contracts with role-based access control mechanisms.
       *           Also provides interfaces to view all members with a given role, and total count of members.
       */
      contract PermissionsEnumerable is IPermissionsEnumerable, Permissions {
          /**
           *  @notice A data structure to store data of members for a given role.
           *
           *  @param index    Current index in the list of accounts that have a role.
           *  @param members  map from index => address of account that has a role
           *  @param indexOf  map from address => index which the account has.
           */
          struct RoleMembers {
              uint256 index;
              mapping(uint256 => address) members;
              mapping(address => uint256) indexOf;
          }
          /// @dev map from keccak256 hash of a role to its members' data. See {RoleMembers}.
          mapping(bytes32 => RoleMembers) private roleMembers;
          /**
           *  @notice         Returns the role-member from a list of members for a role,
           *                  at a given index.
           *  @dev            Returns `member` who has `role`, at `index` of role-members list.
           *                  See struct {RoleMembers}, and mapping {roleMembers}
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param index    Index in list of current members for the role.
           *
           *  @return member  Address of account that has `role`
           */
          function getRoleMember(bytes32 role, uint256 index) external view override returns (address member) {
              uint256 currentIndex = roleMembers[role].index;
              uint256 check;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < currentIndex; i += 1) {
                  if (roleMembers[role].members[i] != address(0)) {
                      if (check == index) {
                          member = roleMembers[role].members[i];
                          return member;
                      }
                      check += 1;
                  } else if (hasRole(role, address(0)) && i == roleMembers[role].indexOf[address(0)]) {
                      check += 1;
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Returns total number of accounts that have a role.
           *  @dev            Returns `count` of accounts that have `role`.
           *                  See struct {RoleMembers}, and mapping {roleMembers}
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *
           *  @return count   Total number of accounts that have `role`
           */
          function getRoleMemberCount(bytes32 role) external view override returns (uint256 count) {
              uint256 currentIndex = roleMembers[role].index;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < currentIndex; i += 1) {
                  if (roleMembers[role].members[i] != address(0)) {
                      count += 1;
                  }
              }
              if (hasRole(role, address(0))) {
                  count += 1;
              }
          }
          /// @dev Revokes `role` from `account`, and removes `account` from {roleMembers}
          ///      See {_removeMember}
          function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal override {
              super._revokeRole(role, account);
              _removeMember(role, account);
          }
          /// @dev Grants `role` to `account`, and adds `account` to {roleMembers}
          ///      See {_addMember}
          function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal override {
              super._setupRole(role, account);
              _addMember(role, account);
          }
          /// @dev adds `account` to {roleMembers}, for `role`
          function _addMember(bytes32 role, address account) internal {
              uint256 idx = roleMembers[role].index;
              roleMembers[role].index += 1;
              roleMembers[role].members[idx] = account;
              roleMembers[role].indexOf[account] = idx;
          }
          /// @dev removes `account` from {roleMembers}, for `role`
          function _removeMember(bytes32 role, address account) internal {
              uint256 idx = roleMembers[role].indexOf[account];
              delete roleMembers[role].members[idx];
              delete roleMembers[role].indexOf[account];
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IPrimarySale.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Primary Sale
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `PrimarySale` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *           the recipient of primary sales, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses information about
       *           primary sales, if desired.
       */
      abstract contract PrimarySale is IPrimarySale {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error PrimarySaleUnauthorized();
          /// @dev The recipient is invalid
          error PrimarySaleInvalidRecipient(address recipient);
          /// @dev The address that receives all primary sales value.
          address private recipient;
          /// @dev Returns primary sale recipient address.
          function primarySaleRecipient() public view override returns (address) {
              return recipient;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Updates primary sale recipient.
           *  @dev            Caller should be authorized to set primary sales info.
           *                  See {_canSetPrimarySaleRecipient}.
           *                  Emits {PrimarySaleRecipientUpdated Event}; See {_setupPrimarySaleRecipient}.
           *
           *  @param _saleRecipient   Address to be set as new recipient of primary sales.
           */
          function setPrimarySaleRecipient(address _saleRecipient) external override {
              if (!_canSetPrimarySaleRecipient()) {
                  revert PrimarySaleUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupPrimarySaleRecipient(_saleRecipient);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set the recipient for all primary sales.
          function _setupPrimarySaleRecipient(address _saleRecipient) internal {
              if (_saleRecipient == address(0)) {
                  revert PrimarySaleInvalidRecipient(_saleRecipient);
              }
              recipient = _saleRecipient;
              emit PrimarySaleRecipientUpdated(_saleRecipient);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether primary sale recipient can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetPrimarySaleRecipient() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IRoyalty.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Royalty
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `Royalty` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *           the recipient of royalty fee and the royalty fee basis points, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic
       *           that uses information about royalty fees, if desired.
       *
       *  @dev     The `Royalty` contract is ERC2981 compliant.
       */
      abstract contract Royalty is IRoyalty {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error RoyaltyUnauthorized();
          /// @dev The recipient is invalid
          error RoyaltyInvalidRecipient(address recipient);
          /// @dev The fee bps exceeded the max value
          error RoyaltyExceededMaxFeeBps(uint256 max, uint256 actual);
          /// @dev The (default) address that receives all royalty value.
          address private royaltyRecipient;
          /// @dev The (default) % of a sale to take as royalty (in basis points).
          uint16 private royaltyBps;
          /// @dev Token ID => royalty recipient and bps for token
          mapping(uint256 => RoyaltyInfo) private royaltyInfoForToken;
          /**
           *  @notice   View royalty info for a given token and sale price.
           *  @dev      Returns royalty amount and recipient for `tokenId` and `salePrice`.
           *  @param tokenId          The tokenID of the NFT for which to query royalty info.
           *  @param salePrice        Sale price of the token.
           *
           *  @return receiver        Address of royalty recipient account.
           *  @return royaltyAmount   Royalty amount calculated at current royaltyBps value.
           */
          function royaltyInfo(
              uint256 tokenId,
              uint256 salePrice
          ) external view virtual override returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount) {
              (address recipient, uint256 bps) = getRoyaltyInfoForToken(tokenId);
              receiver = recipient;
              royaltyAmount = (salePrice * bps) / 10_000;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice          View royalty info for a given token.
           *  @dev             Returns royalty recipient and bps for `_tokenId`.
           *  @param _tokenId  The tokenID of the NFT for which to query royalty info.
           */
          function getRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 _tokenId) public view override returns (address, uint16) {
              RoyaltyInfo memory royaltyForToken = royaltyInfoForToken[_tokenId];
              return
                  royaltyForToken.recipient == address(0)
                      ? (royaltyRecipient, uint16(royaltyBps))
                      : (royaltyForToken.recipient, uint16(royaltyForToken.bps));
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Returns the defualt royalty recipient and BPS for this contract's NFTs.
           */
          function getDefaultRoyaltyInfo() external view override returns (address, uint16) {
              return (royaltyRecipient, uint16(royaltyBps));
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Updates default royalty recipient and bps.
           *  @dev            Caller should be authorized to set royalty info.
           *                  See {_canSetRoyaltyInfo}.
           *                  Emits {DefaultRoyalty Event}; See {_setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo}.
           *
           *  @param _royaltyRecipient   Address to be set as default royalty recipient.
           *  @param _royaltyBps         Updated royalty bps.
           */
          function setDefaultRoyaltyInfo(address _royaltyRecipient, uint256 _royaltyBps) external override {
              if (!_canSetRoyaltyInfo()) {
                  revert RoyaltyUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo(_royaltyRecipient, _royaltyBps);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin update the default royalty recipient and bps.
          function _setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo(address _royaltyRecipient, uint256 _royaltyBps) internal {
              if (_royaltyBps > 10_000) {
                  revert RoyaltyExceededMaxFeeBps(10_000, _royaltyBps);
              }
              royaltyRecipient = _royaltyRecipient;
              royaltyBps = uint16(_royaltyBps);
              emit DefaultRoyalty(_royaltyRecipient, _royaltyBps);
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Updates default royalty recipient and bps for a particular token.
           *  @dev            Sets royalty info for `_tokenId`. Caller should be authorized to set royalty info.
           *                  See {_canSetRoyaltyInfo}.
           *                  Emits {RoyaltyForToken Event}; See {_setupRoyaltyInfoForToken}.
           *
           *  @param _recipient   Address to be set as royalty recipient for given token Id.
           *  @param _bps         Updated royalty bps for the token Id.
           */
          function setRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 _tokenId, address _recipient, uint256 _bps) external override {
              if (!_canSetRoyaltyInfo()) {
                  revert RoyaltyUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupRoyaltyInfoForToken(_tokenId, _recipient, _bps);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set the royalty recipient and bps for a particular token Id.
          function _setupRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 _tokenId, address _recipient, uint256 _bps) internal {
              if (_bps > 10_000) {
                  revert RoyaltyExceededMaxFeeBps(10_000, _bps);
              }
              royaltyInfoForToken[_tokenId] = RoyaltyInfo({ recipient: _recipient, bps: _bps });
              emit RoyaltyForToken(_tokenId, _recipient, _bps);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether royalty info can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetRoyaltyInfo() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.10;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "../lib/NFTMetadataRenderer.sol";
      import "./interface/ISharedMetadata.sol";
      import "../eip/interface/IERC4906.sol";
      abstract contract SharedMetadata is ISharedMetadata, IERC4906 {
          /// @notice Token metadata information
          SharedMetadataInfo public sharedMetadata;
          /// @notice Set shared metadata for NFTs
          function setSharedMetadata(SharedMetadataInfo calldata _metadata) external virtual {
              if (!_canSetSharedMetadata()) {
                  revert("Not authorized");
              }
              _setSharedMetadata(_metadata);
          }
          /**
           *  @dev Sets shared metadata for NFTs.
           *  @param _metadata common metadata for all tokens
           */
          function _setSharedMetadata(SharedMetadataInfo calldata _metadata) internal {
              sharedMetadata = SharedMetadataInfo({
                  name: _metadata.name,
                  description: _metadata.description,
                  imageURI: _metadata.imageURI,
                  animationURI: _metadata.animationURI
              });
              emit BatchMetadataUpdate(0, type(uint256).max);
              emit SharedMetadataUpdated({
                  name: _metadata.name,
                  description: _metadata.description,
                  imageURI: _metadata.imageURI,
                  animationURI: _metadata.animationURI
              });
          }
          /**
           *  @dev Token URI information getter
           *  @param tokenId Token ID to get URI for
           */
          function _getURIFromSharedMetadata(uint256 tokenId) internal view returns (string memory) {
              SharedMetadataInfo memory info = sharedMetadata;
              return
                  NFTMetadataRenderer.createMetadataEdition({
                      name: info.name,
                      description: info.description,
                      imageURI: info.imageURI,
                      animationURI: info.animationURI,
                      tokenOfEdition: tokenId
                  });
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether shared metadata can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetSharedMetadata() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  The interface `IClaimCondition` is written for thirdweb's 'Drop' contracts, which are distribution mechanisms for tokens.
       *
       *  A claim condition defines criteria under which accounts can mint tokens. Claim conditions can be overwritten
       *  or added to by the contract admin. At any moment, there is only one active claim condition.
       */
      interface IClaimCondition {
          /**
           *  @notice The criteria that make up a claim condition.
           *
           *  @param startTimestamp                 The unix timestamp after which the claim condition applies.
           *                                        The same claim condition applies until the `startTimestamp`
           *                                        of the next claim condition.
           *
           *  @param maxClaimableSupply             The maximum total number of tokens that can be claimed under
           *                                        the claim condition.
           *
           *  @param supplyClaimed                  At any given point, the number of tokens that have been claimed
           *                                        under the claim condition.
           *
           *  @param quantityLimitPerWallet         The maximum number of tokens that can be claimed by a wallet.
           *
           *  @param merkleRoot                     The allowlist of addresses that can claim tokens under the claim
           *                                        condition.
           *
           *  @param pricePerToken                  The price required to pay per token claimed.
           *
           *  @param currency                       The currency in which the `pricePerToken` must be paid.
           *
           *  @param metadata                       Claim condition metadata.
           */
          struct ClaimCondition {
              uint256 startTimestamp;
              uint256 maxClaimableSupply;
              uint256 supplyClaimed;
              uint256 quantityLimitPerWallet;
              bytes32 merkleRoot;
              uint256 pricePerToken;
              address currency;
              string metadata;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./IClaimCondition.sol";
      /**
       *  The interface `IClaimConditionMultiPhase` is written for thirdweb's 'Drop' contracts, which are distribution mechanisms for tokens.
       *
       *  An authorized wallet can set a series of claim conditions, ordered by their respective `startTimestamp`.
       *  A claim condition defines criteria under which accounts can mint tokens. Claim conditions can be overwritten
       *  or added to by the contract admin. At any moment, there is only one active claim condition.
       */
      interface IClaimConditionMultiPhase is IClaimCondition {
          /**
           *  @notice The set of all claim conditions, at any given moment.
           *  Claim Phase ID = [currentStartId, currentStartId + length - 1];
           *
           *  @param currentStartId           The uid for the first claim condition amongst the current set of
           *                                  claim conditions. The uid for each next claim condition is one
           *                                  more than the previous claim condition's uid.
           *
           *  @param count                    The total number of phases / claim conditions in the list
           *                                  of claim conditions.
           *
           *  @param conditions                   The claim conditions at a given uid. Claim conditions
           *                                  are ordered in an ascending order by their `startTimestamp`.
           *
           *  @param supplyClaimedByWallet    Map from a claim condition uid and account to supply claimed by account.
           */
          struct ClaimConditionList {
              uint256 currentStartId;
              uint256 count;
              mapping(uint256 => ClaimCondition) conditions;
              mapping(uint256 => mapping(address => uint256)) supplyClaimedByWallet;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `ContractMetadata` is a contract extension for any base contracts. It lets you set a metadata URI
       *  for you contract.
       *
       *  Additionally, `ContractMetadata` is necessary for NFT contracts that want royalties to get distributed on OpenSea.
       */
      interface IContractMetadata {
          /// @dev Returns the metadata URI of the contract.
          function contractURI() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           *  @dev Sets contract URI for the storefront-level metadata of the contract.
           *       Only module admin can call this function.
           */
          function setContractURI(string calldata _uri) external;
          /// @dev Emitted when the contract URI is updated.
          event ContractURIUpdated(string prevURI, string newURI);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./IClaimConditionMultiPhase.sol";
      /**
       *  The interface `IDrop` is written for thirdweb's 'Drop' contracts, which are distribution mechanisms for tokens.
       *
       *  An authorized wallet can set a series of claim conditions, ordered by their respective `startTimestamp`.
       *  A claim condition defines criteria under which accounts can mint tokens. Claim conditions can be overwritten
       *  or added to by the contract admin. At any moment, there is only one active claim condition.
       */
      interface IDrop is IClaimConditionMultiPhase {
          /**
           *  @param proof Proof of concerned wallet's inclusion in an allowlist.
           *  @param quantityLimitPerWallet The total quantity of tokens the allowlisted wallet is eligible to claim over time.
           *  @param pricePerToken The price per token the allowlisted wallet must pay to claim tokens.
           *  @param currency The currency in which the allowlisted wallet must pay the price for claiming tokens.
           */
          struct AllowlistProof {
              bytes32[] proof;
              uint256 quantityLimitPerWallet;
              uint256 pricePerToken;
              address currency;
          }
          /// @notice Emitted when tokens are claimed via `claim`.
          event TokensClaimed(
              uint256 indexed claimConditionIndex,
              address indexed claimer,
              address indexed receiver,
              uint256 startTokenId,
              uint256 quantityClaimed
          );
          /// @notice Emitted when the contract's claim conditions are updated.
          event ClaimConditionsUpdated(ClaimCondition[] claimConditions, bool resetEligibility);
          /**
           *  @notice Lets an account claim a given quantity of NFTs.
           *
           *  @param receiver                       The receiver of the NFTs to claim.
           *  @param quantity                       The quantity of NFTs to claim.
           *  @param currency                       The currency in which to pay for the claim.
           *  @param pricePerToken                  The price per token to pay for the claim.
           *  @param allowlistProof                 The proof of the claimer's inclusion in the merkle root allowlist
           *                                        of the claim conditions that apply.
           *  @param data                           Arbitrary bytes data that can be leveraged in the implementation of this interface.
           */
          function claim(
              address receiver,
              uint256 quantity,
              address currency,
              uint256 pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata allowlistProof,
              bytes memory data
          ) external payable;
          /**
           *  @notice Lets a contract admin (account with `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE`) set claim conditions.
           *
           *  @param phases                   Claim conditions in ascending order by `startTimestamp`.
           *
           *  @param resetClaimEligibility    Whether to honor the restrictions applied to wallets who have claimed tokens in the current conditions,
           *                                  in the new claim conditions being set.
           *
           */
          function setClaimConditions(ClaimCondition[] calldata phases, bool resetClaimEligibility) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       * @dev Provides a function to batch together multiple calls in a single external call.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       */
      interface IMulticall {
          /**
           * @dev Receives and executes a batch of function calls on this contract.
           */
          function multicall(bytes[] calldata data) external returns (bytes[] memory results);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `Ownable` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *  who the 'owner' of the inheriting smart contract is, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses
       *  information about who the contract's owner is.
       */
      interface IOwnable {
          /// @dev Returns the owner of the contract.
          function owner() external view returns (address);
          /// @dev Lets a module admin set a new owner for the contract. The new owner must be a module admin.
          function setOwner(address _newOwner) external;
          /// @dev Emitted when a new Owner is set.
          event OwnerUpdated(address indexed prevOwner, address indexed newOwner);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       * @dev External interface of AccessControl declared to support ERC165 detection.
       */
      interface IPermissions {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `newAdminRole` is set as ``role``'s admin role, replacing `previousAdminRole`
           *
           * `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is the starting admin for all roles, despite
           * {RoleAdminChanged} not being emitted signaling this.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          event RoleAdminChanged(bytes32 indexed role, bytes32 indexed previousAdminRole, bytes32 indexed newAdminRole);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is granted `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call, an admin role
           * bearer except when using {AccessControl-_setupRole}.
           */
          event RoleGranted(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is revoked `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call:
           *   - if using `revokeRole`, it is the admin role bearer
           *   - if using `renounceRole`, it is the role bearer (i.e. `account`)
           */
          event RoleRevoked(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) external view returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
           * {revokeRole}.
           *
           * To change a role's admin, use {AccessControl-_setRoleAdmin}.
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view returns (bytes32);
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
           *
           * Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
           * purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
           * if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
           *
           * If the calling account had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must be `account`.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./IPermissions.sol";
      /**
       * @dev External interface of AccessControlEnumerable declared to support ERC165 detection.
       */
      interface IPermissionsEnumerable is IPermissions {
          /**
           * @dev Returns one of the accounts that have `role`. `index` must be a
           * value between 0 and {getRoleMemberCount}, non-inclusive.
           *
           * Role bearers are not sorted in any particular way, and their ordering may
           * change at any point.
           *
           * WARNING: When using {getRoleMember} and {getRoleMemberCount}, make sure
           * you perform all queries on the same block. See the following
           * [forum post](https://forum.openzeppelin.com/t/iterating-over-elements-on-enumerableset-in-openzeppelin-contracts/2296)
           * for more information.
           */
          function getRoleMember(bytes32 role, uint256 index) external view returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of accounts that have `role`. Can be used
           * together with {getRoleMember} to enumerate all bearers of a role.
           */
          function getRoleMemberCount(bytes32 role) external view returns (uint256);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `Primary` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *  the recipient of primary sales, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses information about
       *  primary sales, if desired.
       */
      interface IPrimarySale {
          /// @dev The adress that receives all primary sales value.
          function primarySaleRecipient() external view returns (address);
          /// @dev Lets a module admin set the default recipient of all primary sales.
          function setPrimarySaleRecipient(address _saleRecipient) external;
          /// @dev Emitted when a new sale recipient is set.
          event PrimarySaleRecipientUpdated(address indexed recipient);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "../../eip/interface/IERC2981.sol";
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `Royalty` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *  the recipient of royalty fee and the royalty fee basis points, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic
       *  that uses information about royalty fees, if desired.
       *
       *  The `Royalty` contract is ERC2981 compliant.
       */
      interface IRoyalty is IERC2981 {
          struct RoyaltyInfo {
              address recipient;
              uint256 bps;
          }
          /// @dev Returns the royalty recipient and fee bps.
          function getDefaultRoyaltyInfo() external view returns (address, uint16);
          /// @dev Lets a module admin update the royalty bps and recipient.
          function setDefaultRoyaltyInfo(address _royaltyRecipient, uint256 _royaltyBps) external;
          /// @dev Lets a module admin set the royalty recipient for a particular token Id.
          function setRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 tokenId, address recipient, uint256 bps) external;
          /// @dev Returns the royalty recipient for a particular token Id.
          function getRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address, uint16);
          /// @dev Emitted when royalty info is updated.
          event DefaultRoyalty(address indexed newRoyaltyRecipient, uint256 newRoyaltyBps);
          /// @dev Emitted when royalty recipient for tokenId is set
          event RoyaltyForToken(uint256 indexed tokenId, address indexed royaltyRecipient, uint256 royaltyBps);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.10;
      /// @author thirdweb
      interface ISharedMetadata {
          /// @notice Emitted when shared metadata is lazy minted.
          event SharedMetadataUpdated(string name, string description, string imageURI, string animationURI);
          /**
           *  @notice Structure for metadata shared across all tokens
           *
           *  @param name Shared name of NFT in metadata
           *  @param description Shared description of NFT in metadata
           *  @param imageURI Shared URI of image to render for NFTs
           *  @param animationURI Shared URI of animation to render for NFTs
           */
          struct SharedMetadataInfo {
              string name;
              string description;
              string imageURI;
              string animationURI;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Set shared metadata for NFTs
           *  @param _metadata common metadata for all tokens
           */
          function setSharedMetadata(SharedMetadataInfo calldata _metadata) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.0 (metatx/ERC2771Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.11;
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Context variant with ERC2771 support.
       */
      abstract contract ERC2771ContextUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
          mapping(address => bool) private _trustedForwarder;
          function __ERC2771Context_init(address[] memory trustedForwarder) internal onlyInitializing {
              __Context_init_unchained();
              __ERC2771Context_init_unchained(trustedForwarder);
          }
          function __ERC2771Context_init_unchained(address[] memory trustedForwarder) internal onlyInitializing {
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < trustedForwarder.length; i++) {
                  _trustedForwarder[trustedForwarder[i]] = true;
              }
          }
          function isTrustedForwarder(address forwarder) public view virtual returns (bool) {
              return _trustedForwarder[forwarder];
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual override returns (address sender) {
              if (isTrustedForwarder(msg.sender)) {
                  // The assembly code is more direct than the Solidity version using `abi.decode`.
                  assembly {
                      sender := shr(96, calldataload(sub(calldatasize(), 20)))
                  }
              } else {
                  return super._msgSender();
              }
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual override returns (bytes calldata) {
              if (isTrustedForwarder(msg.sender)) {
                  return msg.data[:msg.data.length - 20];
              } else {
                  return super._msgData();
              }
          }
          uint256[49] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../../../../../eip/interface/IERC20.sol";
      import { Address } from "../../../../../lib/Address.sol";
      /**
       * @title SafeERC20
       * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
       * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
       * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
       * successful.
       * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
       * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
       */
      library SafeERC20 {
          using Address for address;
          function safeTransfer(IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value) internal {
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
          }
          function safeTransferFrom(IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value) internal {
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
           * {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
           *
           * Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
           * {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
           */
          function safeApprove(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
              // safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
              // or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
              // 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
              require(
                  (value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
                  "SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
              );
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value));
          }
          function safeIncreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
              uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender) + value;
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
          }
          function safeDecreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 oldAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender);
                  require(oldAllowance >= value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero");
                  uint256 newAllowance = oldAllowance - value;
                  _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
           * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
           * @param token The token targeted by the call.
           * @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
           */
          function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20 token, bytes memory data) private {
              // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
              // we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address.functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
              // the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
              bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed");
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // Return data is optional
                  require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed");
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Base64.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Provides a set of functions to operate with Base64 strings.
       *
       * _Available since v4.5._
       */
      library Base64 {
          /**
           * @dev Base64 Encoding/Decoding Table
           */
          string internal constant _TABLE = "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789+/";
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `bytes` to its Bytes64 `string` representation.
           */
          function encode(bytes memory data) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              /**
               * Inspired by Brecht Devos (Brechtpd) implementation - MIT licence
               * https://github.com/Brechtpd/base64/blob/e78d9fd951e7b0977ddca77d92dc85183770daf4/base64.sol
               */
              if (data.length == 0) return "";
              // Loads the table into memory
              string memory table = _TABLE;
              // Encoding takes 3 bytes chunks of binary data from `bytes` data parameter
              // and split into 4 numbers of 6 bits.
              // The final Base64 length should be `bytes` data length multiplied by 4/3 rounded up
              // - `data.length + 2`  -> Round up
              // - `/ 3`              -> Number of 3-bytes chunks
              // - `4 *`              -> 4 characters for each chunk
              string memory result = new string(4 * ((data.length + 2) / 3));
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  // Prepare the lookup table (skip the first "length" byte)
                  let tablePtr := add(table, 1)
                  // Prepare result pointer, jump over length
                  let resultPtr := add(result, 32)
                  // Run over the input, 3 bytes at a time
                  for {
                      let dataPtr := data
                      let endPtr := add(data, mload(data))
                  } lt(dataPtr, endPtr) {
                  } {
                      // Advance 3 bytes
                      dataPtr := add(dataPtr, 3)
                      let input := mload(dataPtr)
                      // To write each character, shift the 3 bytes (18 bits) chunk
                      // 4 times in blocks of 6 bits for each character (18, 12, 6, 0)
                      // and apply logical AND with 0x3F which is the number of
                      // the previous character in the ASCII table prior to the Base64 Table
                      // The result is then added to the table to get the character to write,
                      // and finally write it in the result pointer but with a left shift
                      // of 256 (1 byte) - 8 (1 ASCII char) = 248 bits
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(shr(18, input), 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(shr(12, input), 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(shr(6, input), 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(input, 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                  }
                  // When data `bytes` is not exactly 3 bytes long
                  // it is padded with `=` characters at the end
                  switch mod(mload(data), 3)
                  case 1 {
                      mstore8(sub(resultPtr, 1), 0x3d)
                      mstore8(sub(resultPtr, 2), 0x3d)
                  }
                  case 2 {
                      mstore8(sub(resultPtr, 1), 0x3d)
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      interface IWETH {
          function deposit() external payable;
          function withdraw(uint256 amount) external;
          function transfer(address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /// @author thirdweb, OpenZeppelin Contracts (v4.9.0)
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           *
           * Furthermore, `isContract` will also return true if the target contract within
           * the same transaction is already scheduled for destruction by `SELFDESTRUCT`,
           * which only has an effect at the end of a transaction.
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://consensys.net/diligence/blog/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.8.0/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
           * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
           *
           * _Available since v4.8._
           */
          function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
              address target,
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  if (returndata.length == 0) {
                      // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
                      // otherwise we already know that it was a contract
                      require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
                  }
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason or using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
              // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                      revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                  }
              } else {
                  revert(errorMessage);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      // Helper interfaces
      import { IWETH } from "../infra/interface/IWETH.sol";
      import { SafeERC20, IERC20 } from "../external-deps/openzeppelin/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol";
      library CurrencyTransferLib {
          using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
          error CurrencyTransferLibMismatchedValue(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          error CurrencyTransferLibFailedNativeTransfer(address recipient, uint256 value);
          /// @dev The address interpreted as native token of the chain.
          address public constant NATIVE_TOKEN = 0xEeeeeEeeeEeEeeEeEeEeeEEEeeeeEeeeeeeeEEeE;
          /// @dev Transfers a given amount of currency.
          function transferCurrency(address _currency, address _from, address _to, uint256 _amount) internal {
              if (_amount == 0) {
                  return;
              }
              if (_currency == NATIVE_TOKEN) {
                  safeTransferNativeToken(_to, _amount);
              } else {
                  safeTransferERC20(_currency, _from, _to, _amount);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfers a given amount of currency. (With native token wrapping)
          function transferCurrencyWithWrapper(
              address _currency,
              address _from,
              address _to,
              uint256 _amount,
              address _nativeTokenWrapper
          ) internal {
              if (_amount == 0) {
                  return;
              }
              if (_currency == NATIVE_TOKEN) {
                  if (_from == address(this)) {
                      // withdraw from weth then transfer withdrawn native token to recipient
                      IWETH(_nativeTokenWrapper).withdraw(_amount);
                      safeTransferNativeTokenWithWrapper(_to, _amount, _nativeTokenWrapper);
                  } else if (_to == address(this)) {
                      // store native currency in weth
                      if (_amount != msg.value) {
                          revert CurrencyTransferLibMismatchedValue(msg.value, _amount);
                      }
                      IWETH(_nativeTokenWrapper).deposit{ value: _amount }();
                  } else {
                      safeTransferNativeTokenWithWrapper(_to, _amount, _nativeTokenWrapper);
                  }
              } else {
                  safeTransferERC20(_currency, _from, _to, _amount);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfer `amount` of ERC20 token from `from` to `to`.
          function safeTransferERC20(address _currency, address _from, address _to, uint256 _amount) internal {
              if (_from == _to) {
                  return;
              }
              if (_from == address(this)) {
                  IERC20(_currency).safeTransfer(_to, _amount);
              } else {
                  IERC20(_currency).safeTransferFrom(_from, _to, _amount);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfers `amount` of native token to `to`.
          function safeTransferNativeToken(address to, uint256 value) internal {
              // solhint-disable avoid-low-level-calls
              // slither-disable-next-line low-level-calls
              (bool success, ) = to.call{ value: value }("");
              if (!success) {
                  revert CurrencyTransferLibFailedNativeTransfer(to, value);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfers `amount` of native token to `to`. (With native token wrapping)
          function safeTransferNativeTokenWithWrapper(address to, uint256 value, address _nativeTokenWrapper) internal {
              // solhint-disable avoid-low-level-calls
              // slither-disable-next-line low-level-calls
              (bool success, ) = to.call{ value: value }("");
              if (!success) {
                  IWETH(_nativeTokenWrapper).deposit{ value: value }();
                  IERC20(_nativeTokenWrapper).safeTransfer(to, value);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author OpenZeppelin, thirdweb
      library MerkleProof {
          function verify(bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 root, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
              bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
              uint256 index = 0;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
                  index *= 2;
                  bytes32 proofElement = proof[i];
                  if (computedHash <= proofElement) {
                      // Hash(current computed hash + current element of the proof)
                      computedHash = _efficientHash(computedHash, proofElement);
                  } else {
                      // Hash(current element of the proof + current computed hash)
                      computedHash = _efficientHash(proofElement, computedHash);
                      index += 1;
                  }
              }
              // Check if the computed hash (root) is equal to the provided root
              return (computedHash == root, index);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Implementation of keccak256(abi.encode(a, b)) that doesn't allocate or expand memory.
           */
          function _efficientHash(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32 value) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  mstore(0x00, a)
                  mstore(0x20, b)
                  value := keccak256(0x00, 0x40)
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /* solhint-disable quotes */
      /// @author thirdweb
      /// credits: Zora
      import "./Strings.sol";
      import "../external-deps/openzeppelin/utils/Base64.sol";
      /// NFT metadata library for rendering metadata associated with editions
      library NFTMetadataRenderer {
          /**
           *  @notice Generate edition metadata from storage information as base64-json blob
           *  @dev Combines the media data and metadata
           * @param name Name of NFT in metadata
           * @param description Description of NFT in metadata
           * @param imageURI URI of image to render for edition
           * @param animationURI URI of animation to render for edition
           * @param tokenOfEdition Token ID for specific token
           */
          function createMetadataEdition(
              string memory name,
              string memory description,
              string memory imageURI,
              string memory animationURI,
              uint256 tokenOfEdition
          ) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              string memory _tokenMediaData = tokenMediaData(imageURI, animationURI);
              bytes memory json = createMetadataJSON(name, description, _tokenMediaData, tokenOfEdition);
              return encodeMetadataJSON(json);
          }
          /**
           * @param name Name of NFT in metadata
           * @param description Description of NFT in metadata
           * @param mediaData Data for media to include in json object
           * @param tokenOfEdition Token ID for specific token
           */
          function createMetadataJSON(
              string memory name,
              string memory description,
              string memory mediaData,
              uint256 tokenOfEdition
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              return
                  abi.encodePacked(
                      '{"name": "',
                      name,
                      " ",
                      Strings.toString(tokenOfEdition),
                      '", "',
                      'description": "',
                      description,
                      '", "',
                      mediaData,
                      'properties": {"number": ',
                      Strings.toString(tokenOfEdition),
                      ', "name": "',
                      name,
                      '"}}'
                  );
          }
          /// Encodes the argument json bytes into base64-data uri format
          /// @param json Raw json to base64 and turn into a data-uri
          function encodeMetadataJSON(bytes memory json) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return string(abi.encodePacked("data:application/json;base64,", Base64.encode(json)));
          }
          /// Generates edition metadata from storage information as base64-json blob
          /// Combines the media data and metadata
          /// @param imageUrl URL of image to render for edition
          /// @param animationUrl URL of animation to render for edition
          function tokenMediaData(string memory imageUrl, string memory animationUrl) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bool hasImage = bytes(imageUrl).length > 0;
              bool hasAnimation = bytes(animationUrl).length > 0;
              if (hasImage && hasAnimation) {
                  return string(abi.encodePacked('image": "', imageUrl, '", "animation_url": "', animationUrl, '", "'));
              }
              if (hasImage) {
                  return string(abi.encodePacked('image": "', imageUrl, '", "'));
              }
              if (hasAnimation) {
                  return string(abi.encodePacked('animation_url": "', animationUrl, '", "'));
              }
              return "";
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       * @dev String operations.
       */
      library Strings {
          bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              // Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
              // https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
              if (value == 0) {
                  return "0";
              }
              uint256 temp = value;
              uint256 digits;
              while (temp != 0) {
                  digits++;
                  temp /= 10;
              }
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
              while (value != 0) {
                  digits -= 1;
                  buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
                  value /= 10;
              }
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              if (value == 0) {
                  return "0x00";
              }
              uint256 temp = value;
              uint256 length = 0;
              while (temp != 0) {
                  length++;
                  temp >>= 8;
              }
              return toHexString(value, length);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
              buffer[0] = "0";
              buffer[1] = "x";
              for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
                  buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
                  value >>= 4;
              }
              require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hexadecimal representation of `value`.
          /// The output is prefixed with "0x", encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte,
          /// and the alphabets are capitalized conditionally according to
          /// https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-55
          function toHexStringChecksummed(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              str = toHexString(value);
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let mask := shl(6, div(not(0), 255)) // `0b010000000100000000 ...`
                  let o := add(str, 0x22)
                  let hashed := and(keccak256(o, 40), mul(34, mask)) // `0b10001000 ... `
                  let t := shl(240, 136) // `0b10001000 << 240`
                  for {
                      let i := 0
                  } 1 {
                  } {
                      mstore(add(i, i), mul(t, byte(i, hashed)))
                      i := add(i, 1)
                      if eq(i, 20) {
                          break
                      }
                  }
                  mstore(o, xor(mload(o), shr(1, and(mload(0x00), and(mload(o), mask)))))
                  o := add(o, 0x20)
                  mstore(o, xor(mload(o), shr(1, and(mload(0x20), and(mload(o), mask)))))
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hexadecimal representation of `value`.
          /// The output is prefixed with "0x" and encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexString(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              str = toHexStringNoPrefix(value);
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let strLength := add(mload(str), 2) // Compute the length.
                  mstore(str, 0x3078) // Write the "0x" prefix.
                  str := sub(str, 2) // Move the pointer.
                  mstore(str, strLength) // Write the length.
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hexadecimal representation of `value`.
          /// The output is encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexStringNoPrefix(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  str := mload(0x40)
                  // Allocate the memory.
                  // We need 0x20 bytes for the trailing zeros padding, 0x20 bytes for the length,
                  // 0x02 bytes for the prefix, and 0x28 bytes for the digits.
                  // The next multiple of 0x20 above (0x20 + 0x20 + 0x02 + 0x28) is 0x80.
                  mstore(0x40, add(str, 0x80))
                  // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space.
                  mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566)
                  str := add(str, 2)
                  mstore(str, 40)
                  let o := add(str, 0x20)
                  mstore(add(o, 40), 0)
                  value := shl(96, value)
                  // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
                  // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
                  for {
                      let i := 0
                  } 1 {
                  } {
                      let p := add(o, add(i, i))
                      let temp := byte(i, value)
                      mstore8(add(p, 1), mload(and(temp, 15)))
                      mstore8(p, mload(shr(4, temp)))
                      i := add(i, 1)
                      if eq(i, 20) {
                          break
                      }
                  }
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hex encoded string from the raw bytes.
          /// The output is encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexString(bytes memory raw) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              str = toHexStringNoPrefix(raw);
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let strLength := add(mload(str), 2) // Compute the length.
                  mstore(str, 0x3078) // Write the "0x" prefix.
                  str := sub(str, 2) // Move the pointer.
                  mstore(str, strLength) // Write the length.
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hex encoded string from the raw bytes.
          /// The output is encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexStringNoPrefix(bytes memory raw) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let length := mload(raw)
                  str := add(mload(0x40), 2) // Skip 2 bytes for the optional prefix.
                  mstore(str, add(length, length)) // Store the length of the output.
                  // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space.
                  mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566)
                  let o := add(str, 0x20)
                  let end := add(raw, length)
                  for {
                  } iszero(eq(raw, end)) {
                  } {
                      raw := add(raw, 1)
                      mstore8(add(o, 1), mload(and(mload(raw), 15)))
                      mstore8(o, mload(and(shr(4, mload(raw)), 15)))
                      o := add(o, 2)
                  }
                  mstore(o, 0) // Zeroize the slot after the string.
                  mstore(0x40, add(o, 0x20)) // Allocate the memory.
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.11;
      /// @author thirdweb
      //   $$\\     $$\\       $$\\                 $$\\                         $$\\
      //   $$ |    $$ |      \\__|                $$ |                        $$ |
      // $$$$$$\\   $$$$$$$\\  $$\\  $$$$$$\\   $$$$$$$ |$$\\  $$\\  $$\\  $$$$$$\\  $$$$$$$\\
      // \\_$$  _|  $$  __$$\\ $$ |$$  __$$\\ $$  __$$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$  __$$\\ $$  __$$\\
      //   $$ |    $$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |  \\__|$$ /  $$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$$$$$$$ |$$ |  $$ |
      //   $$ |$$\\ $$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |      $$ |  $$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$   ____|$$ |  $$ |
      //   \\$$$$  |$$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |      \\$$$$$$$ |\\$$$$$\\$$$$  |\\$$$$$$$\\ $$$$$$$  |
      //    \\____/ \\__|  \\__|\\__|\\__|       \\_______| \\_____\\____/  \\_______|\\_______/
      //  ==========  External imports    ==========
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/utils/StringsUpgradeable.sol";
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/interfaces/IERC2981Upgradeable.sol";
      import "../../eip/queryable/ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol";
      //  ==========  Internal imports    ==========
      import "../../external-deps/openzeppelin/metatx/ERC2771ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../../lib/CurrencyTransferLib.sol";
      //  ==========  Features    ==========
      import "../../extension/Multicall.sol";
      import "../../extension/ContractMetadata.sol";
      import "../../extension/Royalty.sol";
      import "../../extension/PrimarySale.sol";
      import "../../extension/Ownable.sol";
      import "../../extension/SharedMetadata.sol";
      import "../../extension/PermissionsEnumerable.sol";
      import "../../extension/Drop.sol";
      contract OpenEditionERC721 is
          Initializable,
          ContractMetadata,
          Royalty,
          PrimarySale,
          Ownable,
          SharedMetadata,
          PermissionsEnumerable,
          Drop,
          ERC2771ContextUpgradeable,
          Multicall,
          ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable
      {
          using StringsUpgradeable for uint256;
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                                  State variables
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Only transfers to or from TRANSFER_ROLE holders are valid, when transfers are restricted.
          bytes32 private transferRole;
          /// @dev Only MINTER_ROLE holders can update the shared metadata of tokens.
          bytes32 private minterRole;
          /// @dev Max bps in the thirdweb system.
          uint256 private constant MAX_BPS = 10_000;
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                          Constructor + initializer logic
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          constructor() initializer {}
          /// @dev Initializes the contract, like a constructor.
          function initialize(
              address _defaultAdmin,
              string memory _name,
              string memory _symbol,
              string memory _contractURI,
              address[] memory _trustedForwarders,
              address _saleRecipient,
              address _royaltyRecipient,
              uint128 _royaltyBps
          ) external initializerERC721A initializer {
              bytes32 _transferRole = keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE");
              bytes32 _minterRole = keccak256("MINTER_ROLE");
              // Initialize inherited contracts, most base-like -> most derived.
              __ERC2771Context_init(_trustedForwarders);
              __ERC721A_init(_name, _symbol);
              _setupContractURI(_contractURI);
              _setupOwner(_defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(_minterRole, _defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(_transferRole, _defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(_transferRole, address(0));
              _setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo(_royaltyRecipient, _royaltyBps);
              _setupPrimarySaleRecipient(_saleRecipient);
              transferRole = _transferRole;
              minterRole = _minterRole;
          }
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                              ERC 165 / 721 / 2981 logic
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Returns the URI for a given tokenId.
          function tokenURI(
              uint256 _tokenId
          ) public view virtual override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable) returns (string memory) {
              if (!_exists(_tokenId)) {
                  revert("!ID");
              }
              return _getURIFromSharedMetadata(_tokenId);
          }
          /// @dev See ERC 165
          function supportsInterface(
              bytes4 interfaceId
          ) public view virtual override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC165, IERC721AUpgradeable) returns (bool) {
              return super.supportsInterface(interfaceId) || type(IERC2981Upgradeable).interfaceId == interfaceId;
          }
          /// @dev The start token ID for the contract.
          function _startTokenId() internal pure override returns (uint256) {
              return 1;
          }
          function startTokenId() public pure returns (uint256) {
              return _startTokenId();
          }
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                              Internal functions
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Collects and distributes the primary sale value of NFTs being claimed.
          function _collectPriceOnClaim(
              address _primarySaleRecipient,
              uint256 _quantityToClaim,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken
          ) internal override {
              if (_pricePerToken == 0) {
                  require(msg.value == 0, "!Value");
                  return;
              }
              uint256 totalPrice = _quantityToClaim * _pricePerToken;
              bool validMsgValue;
              if (_currency == CurrencyTransferLib.NATIVE_TOKEN) {
                  validMsgValue = msg.value == totalPrice;
              } else {
                  validMsgValue = msg.value == 0;
              }
              require(validMsgValue, "!V");
              address saleRecipient = _primarySaleRecipient == address(0) ? primarySaleRecipient() : _primarySaleRecipient;
              CurrencyTransferLib.transferCurrency(_currency, _msgSender(), saleRecipient, totalPrice);
          }
          /// @dev Transfers the NFTs being claimed.
          function _transferTokensOnClaim(
              address _to,
              uint256 _quantityBeingClaimed
          ) internal override returns (uint256 startTokenId_) {
              startTokenId_ = _nextTokenId();
              _safeMint(_to, _quantityBeingClaimed);
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether primary sale recipient can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetPrimarySaleRecipient() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether owner can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetOwner() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether royalty info can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetRoyaltyInfo() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether contract metadata can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetContractURI() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether platform fee info can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetClaimConditions() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether the shared metadata of tokens can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetSharedMetadata() internal view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(minterRole, _msgSender());
          }
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                              Miscellaneous
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /**
           * Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
           */
          function totalMinted() external view returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  return _nextTokenId() - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /// @dev The tokenId of the next NFT that will be minted / lazy minted.
          function nextTokenIdToMint() external view returns (uint256) {
              return _nextTokenId();
          }
          /// @dev The next token ID of the NFT that can be claimed.
          function nextTokenIdToClaim() external view returns (uint256) {
              return _nextTokenId();
          }
          /// @dev Burns `tokenId`. See {ERC721-_burn}.
          function burn(uint256 tokenId) external virtual {
              // note: ERC721AUpgradeable's `_burn(uint256,bool)` internally checks for token approvals.
              _burn(tokenId, true);
          }
          /// @dev See {ERC721-_beforeTokenTransfer}.
          function _beforeTokenTransfers(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 startTokenId_,
              uint256 quantity
          ) internal virtual override {
              super._beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, startTokenId_, quantity);
              // if transfer is restricted on the contract, we still want to allow burning and minting
              if (!hasRole(transferRole, address(0)) && from != address(0) && to != address(0)) {
                  if (!hasRole(transferRole, from) && !hasRole(transferRole, to)) {
                      revert("!T");
                  }
              }
          }
          function _dropMsgSender() internal view virtual override returns (address) {
              return _msgSender();
          }
          function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual override returns (address) {
              return _msgSender();
          }
          function _msgSender()
              internal
              view
              virtual
              override(ERC2771ContextUpgradeable, Multicall)
              returns (address sender)
          {
              return ERC2771ContextUpgradeable._msgSender();
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (interfaces/IERC2981.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../utils/introspection/IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard.
       *
       * A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal
       * support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants.
       *
       * _Available since v4.5._
       */
      interface IERC2981Upgradeable is IERC165Upgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of
           * exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be paid in that same unit of exchange.
           */
          function royaltyInfo(
              uint256 tokenId,
              uint256 salePrice
          ) external view returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
       * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
       * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
       * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
       *
       * The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be
       * reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in
       * case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized.
       *
       * For example:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```solidity
       * contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable {
       *     function initialize() initializer public {
       *         __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK");
       *     }
       * }
       *
       * contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable {
       *     function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public {
       *         __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken");
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
       * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
       *
       * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
       * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
       *
       * [CAUTION]
       * ====
       * Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized.
       *
       * An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation
       * contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke
       * the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```
       * /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
       * constructor() {
       *     _disableInitializers();
       * }
       * ```
       * ====
       */
      abstract contract Initializable {
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
           * @custom:oz-retyped-from bool
           */
          uint8 private _initialized;
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
           */
          bool private _initializing;
          /**
           * @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized.
           */
          event Initialized(uint8 version);
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope,
           * `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a
           * constructor.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier initializer() {
              bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing;
              require(
                  (isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1),
                  "Initializable: contract is already initialized"
              );
              _initialized = 1;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = true;
              }
              _;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = false;
                  emit Initialized(1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the
           * contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be
           * used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that
           * are added through upgrades and that require initialization.
           *
           * When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer`
           * cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert.
           *
           * Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in
           * a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator.
           *
           * WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) {
              require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized");
              _initialized = version;
              _initializing = true;
              _;
              _initializing = false;
              emit Initialized(version);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
           * {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly.
           */
          modifier onlyInitializing() {
              require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call.
           * Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized
           * to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called
           * through proxies.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed.
           */
          function _disableInitializers() internal virtual {
              require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing");
              if (_initialized != type(uint8).max) {
                  _initialized = type(uint8).max;
                  emit Initialized(type(uint8).max);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the highest version that has been initialized. See {reinitializer}.
           */
          function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) {
              return _initialized;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if the contract is currently initializing. See {onlyInitializing}.
           */
          function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) {
              return _initializing;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library AddressUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           *
           * Furthermore, `isContract` will also return true if the target contract within
           * the same transaction is already scheduled for destruction by `SELFDESTRUCT`,
           * which only has an effect at the end of a transaction.
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://consensys.net/diligence/blog/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.8.0/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
           * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
           *
           * _Available since v4.8._
           */
          function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
              address target,
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  if (returndata.length == 0) {
                      // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
                      // otherwise we already know that it was a contract
                      require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
                  }
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason or using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
              // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                      revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                  }
              } else {
                  revert(errorMessage);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
       * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
       * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
       * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
       * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
       * is concerned).
       *
       * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
       */
      abstract contract ContextUpgradeable is Initializable {
          function __Context_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __Context_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
              return msg.data;
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[50] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (utils/Strings.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./math/MathUpgradeable.sol";
      import "./math/SignedMathUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev String operations.
       */
      library StringsUpgradeable {
          bytes16 private constant _SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
          uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20;
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 length = MathUpgradeable.log10(value) + 1;
                  string memory buffer = new string(length);
                  uint256 ptr;
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      ptr := add(buffer, add(32, length))
                  }
                  while (true) {
                      ptr--;
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          mstore8(ptr, byte(mod(value, 10), _SYMBOLS))
                      }
                      value /= 10;
                      if (value == 0) break;
                  }
                  return buffer;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `int256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(int256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return string(abi.encodePacked(value < 0 ? "-" : "", toString(SignedMathUpgradeable.abs(value))));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  return toHexString(value, MathUpgradeable.log256(value) + 1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
              buffer[0] = "0";
              buffer[1] = "x";
              for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
                  buffer[i] = _SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
                  value >>= 4;
              }
              require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if the two strings are equal.
           */
          function equal(string memory a, string memory b) internal pure returns (bool) {
              return keccak256(bytes(a)) == keccak256(bytes(b));
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
       *
       * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
       * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
       *
       * For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
       */
      interface IERC165Upgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (utils/math/Math.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Standard math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
       */
      library MathUpgradeable {
          enum Rounding {
              Down, // Toward negative infinity
              Up, // Toward infinity
              Zero // Toward zero
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers.
           */
          function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a > b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers.
           */
          function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the average of two numbers. The result is rounded towards
           * zero.
           */
          function average(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b) / 2 can overflow.
              return (a & b) + (a ^ b) / 2;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the ceiling of the division of two numbers.
           *
           * This differs from standard division with `/` in that it rounds up instead
           * of rounding down.
           */
          function ceilDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b - 1) / b can overflow on addition, so we distribute.
              return a == 0 ? 0 : (a - 1) / b + 1;
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates floor(x * y / denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0
           * @dev Original credit to Remco Bloemen under MIT license (https://xn--2-umb.com/21/muldiv)
           * with further edits by Uniswap Labs also under MIT license.
           */
          function mulDiv(uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator) internal pure returns (uint256 result) {
              unchecked {
                  // 512-bit multiply [prod1 prod0] = x * y. Compute the product mod 2^256 and mod 2^256 - 1, then use
                  // use the Chinese Remainder Theorem to reconstruct the 512 bit result. The result is stored in two 256
                  // variables such that product = prod1 * 2^256 + prod0.
                  uint256 prod0; // Least significant 256 bits of the product
                  uint256 prod1; // Most significant 256 bits of the product
                  assembly {
                      let mm := mulmod(x, y, not(0))
                      prod0 := mul(x, y)
                      prod1 := sub(sub(mm, prod0), lt(mm, prod0))
                  }
                  // Handle non-overflow cases, 256 by 256 division.
                  if (prod1 == 0) {
                      // Solidity will revert if denominator == 0, unlike the div opcode on its own.
                      // The surrounding unchecked block does not change this fact.
                      // See https://docs.soliditylang.org/en/latest/control-structures.html#checked-or-unchecked-arithmetic.
                      return prod0 / denominator;
                  }
                  // Make sure the result is less than 2^256. Also prevents denominator == 0.
                  require(denominator > prod1, "Math: mulDiv overflow");
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // 512 by 256 division.
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // Make division exact by subtracting the remainder from [prod1 prod0].
                  uint256 remainder;
                  assembly {
                      // Compute remainder using mulmod.
                      remainder := mulmod(x, y, denominator)
                      // Subtract 256 bit number from 512 bit number.
                      prod1 := sub(prod1, gt(remainder, prod0))
                      prod0 := sub(prod0, remainder)
                  }
                  // Factor powers of two out of denominator and compute largest power of two divisor of denominator. Always >= 1.
                  // See https://cs.stackexchange.com/q/138556/92363.
                  // Does not overflow because the denominator cannot be zero at this stage in the function.
                  uint256 twos = denominator & (~denominator + 1);
                  assembly {
                      // Divide denominator by twos.
                      denominator := div(denominator, twos)
                      // Divide [prod1 prod0] by twos.
                      prod0 := div(prod0, twos)
                      // Flip twos such that it is 2^256 / twos. If twos is zero, then it becomes one.
                      twos := add(div(sub(0, twos), twos), 1)
                  }
                  // Shift in bits from prod1 into prod0.
                  prod0 |= prod1 * twos;
                  // Invert denominator mod 2^256. Now that denominator is an odd number, it has an inverse modulo 2^256 such
                  // that denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^256. Compute the inverse by starting with a seed that is correct for
                  // four bits. That is, denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^4.
                  uint256 inverse = (3 * denominator) ^ 2;
                  // Use the Newton-Raphson iteration to improve the precision. Thanks to Hensel's lifting lemma, this also works
                  // in modular arithmetic, doubling the correct bits in each step.
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^8
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^16
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^32
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^64
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^128
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^256
                  // Because the division is now exact we can divide by multiplying with the modular inverse of denominator.
                  // This will give us the correct result modulo 2^256. Since the preconditions guarantee that the outcome is
                  // less than 2^256, this is the final result. We don't need to compute the high bits of the result and prod1
                  // is no longer required.
                  result = prod0 * inverse;
                  return result;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates x * y / denominator with full precision, following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function mulDiv(uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = mulDiv(x, y, denominator);
              if (rounding == Rounding.Up && mulmod(x, y, denominator) > 0) {
                  result += 1;
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the square root of a number. If the number is not a perfect square, the value is rounded down.
           *
           * Inspired by Henry S. Warren, Jr.'s "Hacker's Delight" (Chapter 11).
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              if (a == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              // For our first guess, we get the biggest power of 2 which is smaller than the square root of the target.
              //
              // We know that the "msb" (most significant bit) of our target number `a` is a power of 2 such that we have
              // `msb(a) <= a < 2*msb(a)`. This value can be written `msb(a)=2**k` with `k=log2(a)`.
              //
              // This can be rewritten `2**log2(a) <= a < 2**(log2(a) + 1)`
              // → `sqrt(2**k) <= sqrt(a) < sqrt(2**(k+1))`
              // → `2**(k/2) <= sqrt(a) < 2**((k+1)/2) <= 2**(k/2 + 1)`
              //
              // Consequently, `2**(log2(a) / 2)` is a good first approximation of `sqrt(a)` with at least 1 correct bit.
              uint256 result = 1 << (log2(a) >> 1);
              // At this point `result` is an estimation with one bit of precision. We know the true value is a uint128,
              // since it is the square root of a uint256. Newton's method converges quadratically (precision doubles at
              // every iteration). We thus need at most 7 iteration to turn our partial result with one bit of precision
              // into the expected uint128 result.
              unchecked {
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  return min(result, a / result);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates sqrt(a), following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = sqrt(a);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && result * result < a ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 128;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      value >>= 8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 4 > 0) {
                      value >>= 4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 2 > 0) {
                      value >>= 2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 1 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log2(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >= 10 ** 64) {
                      value /= 10 ** 64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 32) {
                      value /= 10 ** 32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 16) {
                      value /= 10 ** 16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 8) {
                      value /= 10 ** 8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 4) {
                      value /= 10 ** 4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 2) {
                      value /= 10 ** 2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 1) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log10(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 10 ** result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 256, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           *
           * Adding one to the result gives the number of pairs of hex symbols needed to represent `value` as a hex string.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 256, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log256(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << (result << 3) < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/math/SignedMath.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Standard signed math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
       */
      library SignedMathUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the largest of two signed numbers.
           */
          function max(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              return a > b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the smallest of two signed numbers.
           */
          function min(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the average of two signed numbers without overflow.
           * The result is rounded towards zero.
           */
          function average(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              // Formula from the book "Hacker's Delight"
              int256 x = (a & b) + ((a ^ b) >> 1);
              return x + (int256(uint256(x) >> 255) & (a ^ b));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the absolute unsigned value of a signed value.
           */
          function abs(int256 n) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  // must be unchecked in order to support `n = type(int256).min`
                  return uint256(n >= 0 ? n : -n);
              }
          }
      }
      

      File 3 of 3: OpenEditionERC721
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
       * [EIP](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165).
       *
       * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
       * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
       *
       * For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
       */
      interface IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @title ERC20 interface
       * @dev see https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20
       */
      interface IERC20 {
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          function balanceOf(address who) external view returns (uint256);
          function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
          function transfer(address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
          function approve(address spender, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./IERC165.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard.
       *
       * A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal
       * support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants.
       *
       * _Available since v4.5._
       */
      interface IERC2981 is IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of
           * exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be payed in that same unit of exchange.
           */
          function royaltyInfo(
              uint256 tokenId,
              uint256 salePrice
          ) external view returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.11;
      import "./IERC165.sol";
      import "./IERC721.sol";
      interface IERC4906 is IERC165 {
          /// @dev This event emits when the metadata of a token is changed.
          /// So that the third-party platforms such as NFT market could
          /// timely update the images and related attributes of the NFT.
          event MetadataUpdate(uint256 _tokenId);
          /// @dev This event emits when the metadata of a range of tokens is changed.
          /// So that the third-party platforms such as NFT market could
          /// timely update the images and related attributes of the NFTs.
          event BatchMetadataUpdate(uint256 _fromTokenId, uint256 _toTokenId);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract.
       */
      interface IERC721 {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
           * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import "./IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol";
      import "./ERC721AUpgradeable.sol";
      import "./ERC721A__Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @title ERC721AQueryable.
       *
       * @dev ERC721A subclass with convenience query functions.
       */
      abstract contract ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is
          ERC721A__Initializable,
          ERC721AUpgradeable,
          IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable
      {
          function __ERC721AQueryable_init() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained();
          }
          function __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {}
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
           *
           * - `addr = address(0)`
           * - `startTimestamp = 0`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = 0`
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is burned:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
           * - `burned = true`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
           *
           * Otherwise:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
           */
          function explicitOwnershipOf(
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public view virtual override returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
              unchecked {
                  if (tokenId >= _startTokenId()) {
                      if (tokenId < _nextTokenId()) {
                          // If the `tokenId` is within bounds,
                          // scan backwards for the initialized ownership slot.
                          while (!_ownershipIsInitialized(tokenId)) --tokenId;
                          return _ownershipAt(tokenId);
                      }
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
           * in the range [`start`, `stop`)
           * (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
           *
           * This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
           * grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `start < stop`
           */
          function tokensOfOwnerIn(
              address owner,
              uint256 start,
              uint256 stop
          ) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
              return _tokensOfOwnerIn(owner, start, stop);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
           * It is meant to be called off-chain.
           *
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
           * multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
           * an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
           */
          function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
              uint256 start = _startTokenId();
              uint256 stop = _nextTokenId();
              uint256[] memory tokenIds;
              if (start != stop) tokenIds = _tokensOfOwnerIn(owner, start, stop);
              return tokenIds;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Helper function for returning an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * Note that this function is optimized for smaller bytecode size over runtime gas,
           * since it is meant to be called off-chain.
           */
          function _tokensOfOwnerIn(address owner, uint256 start, uint256 stop) private view returns (uint256[] memory) {
              unchecked {
                  if (start >= stop) _revert(InvalidQueryRange.selector);
                  // Set `start = max(start, _startTokenId())`.
                  if (start < _startTokenId()) {
                      start = _startTokenId();
                  }
                  uint256 stopLimit = _nextTokenId();
                  // Set `stop = min(stop, stopLimit)`.
                  if (stop >= stopLimit) {
                      stop = stopLimit;
                  }
                  uint256[] memory tokenIds;
                  uint256 tokenIdsMaxLength = balanceOf(owner);
                  bool startLtStop = start < stop;
                  assembly {
                      // Set `tokenIdsMaxLength` to zero if `start` is less than `stop`.
                      tokenIdsMaxLength := mul(tokenIdsMaxLength, startLtStop)
                  }
                  if (tokenIdsMaxLength != 0) {
                      // Set `tokenIdsMaxLength = min(balanceOf(owner), stop - start)`,
                      // to cater for cases where `balanceOf(owner)` is too big.
                      if (stop - start <= tokenIdsMaxLength) {
                          tokenIdsMaxLength = stop - start;
                      }
                      assembly {
                          // Grab the free memory pointer.
                          tokenIds := mload(0x40)
                          // Allocate one word for the length, and `tokenIdsMaxLength` words
                          // for the data. `shl(5, x)` is equivalent to `mul(32, x)`.
                          mstore(0x40, add(tokenIds, shl(5, add(tokenIdsMaxLength, 1))))
                      }
                      // We need to call `explicitOwnershipOf(start)`,
                      // because the slot at `start` may not be initialized.
                      TokenOwnership memory ownership = explicitOwnershipOf(start);
                      address currOwnershipAddr;
                      // If the starting slot exists (i.e. not burned),
                      // initialize `currOwnershipAddr`.
                      // `ownership.address` will not be zero,
                      // as `start` is clamped to the valid token ID range.
                      if (!ownership.burned) {
                          currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
                      }
                      uint256 tokenIdsIdx;
                      // Use a do-while, which is slightly more efficient for this case,
                      // as the array will at least contain one element.
                      do {
                          ownership = _ownershipAt(start);
                          assembly {
                              switch mload(add(ownership, 0x40))
                              // if `ownership.burned == false`.
                              case 0 {
                                  // if `ownership.addr != address(0)`.
                                  // The `addr` already has it's upper 96 bits clearned,
                                  // since it is written to memory with regular Solidity.
                                  if mload(ownership) {
                                      currOwnershipAddr := mload(ownership)
                                  }
                                  // if `currOwnershipAddr == owner`.
                                  // The `shl(96, x)` is to make the comparison agnostic to any
                                  // dirty upper 96 bits in `owner`.
                                  if iszero(shl(96, xor(currOwnershipAddr, owner))) {
                                      tokenIdsIdx := add(tokenIdsIdx, 1)
                                      mstore(add(tokenIds, shl(5, tokenIdsIdx)), start)
                                  }
                              }
                              // Otherwise, reset `currOwnershipAddr`.
                              // This handles the case of batch burned tokens
                              // (burned bit of first slot set, remaining slots left uninitialized).
                              default {
                                  currOwnershipAddr := 0
                              }
                              start := add(start, 1)
                          }
                      } while (!(start == stop || tokenIdsIdx == tokenIdsMaxLength));
                      // Store the length of the array.
                      assembly {
                          mstore(tokenIds, tokenIdsIdx)
                      }
                  }
                  return tokenIds;
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      library ERC721AStorage {
          // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
          struct TokenApprovalRef {
              address value;
          }
          struct Layout {
              // =============================================================
              //                            STORAGE
              // =============================================================
              // The next token ID to be minted.
              uint256 _currentIndex;
              // The number of tokens burned.
              uint256 _burnCounter;
              // Token name
              string _name;
              // Token symbol
              string _symbol;
              // Mapping from token ID to ownership details
              // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
              // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
              //
              // Bits Layout:
              // - [0..159]   `addr`
              // - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
              // - [224]      `burned`
              // - [225]      `nextInitialized`
              // - [232..255] `extraData`
              mapping(uint256 => uint256) _packedOwnerships;
              // Mapping owner address to address data.
              //
              // Bits Layout:
              // - [0..63]    `balance`
              // - [64..127]  `numberMinted`
              // - [128..191] `numberBurned`
              // - [192..255] `aux`
              mapping(address => uint256) _packedAddressData;
              // Mapping from token ID to approved address.
              mapping(uint256 => ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef) _tokenApprovals;
              // Mapping from owner to operator approvals
              mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) _operatorApprovals;
          }
          bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256("ERC721A.contracts.storage.ERC721A");
          function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
              bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
              assembly {
                  l.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import "./IERC721AUpgradeable.sol";
      import { ERC721AStorage } from "./ERC721AStorage.sol";
      import "./ERC721A__Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
       */
      interface ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable {
          function onERC721Received(
              address operator,
              address from,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external returns (bytes4);
      }
      /**
       * @title ERC721A
       *
       * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
       * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
       * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
       *
       * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
       * starting from `_startTokenId()`.
       *
       * Assumptions:
       *
       * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
       * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
       */
      contract ERC721AUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable {
          using ERC721AStorage for ERC721AStorage.Layout;
          // =============================================================
          //                           CONSTANTS
          // =============================================================
          // Mask of an entry in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
          // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
          // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
          // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
          // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
          // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
          // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
          // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
          // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
          // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
          // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
          // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
          // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
          // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
          // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
          // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
          uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
          // The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
          // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
          bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
              0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
          // =============================================================
          //                          CONSTRUCTOR
          // =============================================================
          function __ERC721A_init(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              __ERC721A_init_unchained(name_, symbol_);
          }
          function __ERC721A_init_unchained(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._name = name_;
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol = symbol_;
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = _startTokenId();
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                   TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the starting token ID.
           * To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
           */
          function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
           */
          function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
              // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
              unchecked {
                  return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
           */
          function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
              // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
              unchecked {
                  return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
           */
          function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                    ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              if (owner == address(0)) _revert(BalanceQueryForZeroAddress.selector);
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
           */
          function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return
                  (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
           */
          function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return
                  (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           */
          function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
              return uint64(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
          }
          /**
           * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
           */
          function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner];
              uint256 auxCasted;
              // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  auxCasted := aux
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
              // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
              // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
              // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
              return
                  interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
                  interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
                  interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._name;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) _revert(URIQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
              string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
              return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : "";
          }
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
              return "";
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                     OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
           * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
           */
          function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
           */
          function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether the ownership slot at `index` is initialized.
           * An uninitialized slot does not necessarily mean that the slot has no owner.
           */
          function _ownershipIsInitialized(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] != 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
           */
          function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
              if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
              }
          }
          /**
           * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 packed) {
              if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
                  packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId];
                  // If the data at the starting slot does not exist, start the scan.
                  if (packed == 0) {
                      if (tokenId >= ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
                      // Invariant:
                      // There will always be an initialized ownership slot
                      // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                      // before an unintialized ownership slot
                      // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                      // Hence, `tokenId` will not underflow.
                      //
                      // We can directly compare the packed value.
                      // If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
                      for (;;) {
                          unchecked {
                              packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[--tokenId];
                          }
                          if (packed == 0) continue;
                          if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) return packed;
                          // Otherwise, the token is burned, and we must revert.
                          // This handles the case of batch burned tokens, where only the burned bit
                          // of the starting slot is set, and remaining slots are left uninitialized.
                          _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
                      }
                  }
                  // Otherwise, the data exists and we can skip the scan.
                  // This is possible because we have already achieved the target condition.
                  // This saves 2143 gas on transfers of initialized tokens.
                  // If the token is not burned, return `packed`. Otherwise, revert.
                  if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) return packed;
              }
              _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
           */
          function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
              ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
              ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
              ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
              ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
           */
          function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
                  result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
           */
          function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
              // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
              assembly {
                  // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
                  result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                      APPROVAL OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. See {ERC721A-_approve}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              _approve(to, tokenId, true);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) _revert(ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
              emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
           *
           * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
           */
          function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool result) {
              if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
                  if (tokenId < ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                      uint256 packed;
                      while ((packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId]) == 0) --tokenId;
                      result = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0;
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
           */
          function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
              address approvedAddress,
              address owner,
              address msgSender
          ) private pure returns (bool result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
                  result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(
              uint256 tokenId
          ) private view returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) {
              ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId];
              // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
              assembly {
                  approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
                  approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                      TRANSFER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
              // Mask `from` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
              from = address(uint160(uint256(uint160(from)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS));
              if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) _revert(TransferFromIncorrectOwner.selector);
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
              // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
              if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) _revert(TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
                  --ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
                  ++ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the next owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
              // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
              uint256 toMasked = uint256(uint160(to)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS;
              assembly {
                  // Emit the `Transfer` event.
                  log4(
                      0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
                      0, // End of data (0, since no data).
                      _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
                      from, // `from`.
                      toMasked, // `to`.
                      tokenId // `tokenId`.
                  )
              }
              if (toMasked == 0) _revert(TransferToZeroAddress.selector);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, "");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) public payable virtual override {
              transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
              if (to.code.length != 0)
                  if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
                      _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                  }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called before burning one token.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _beforeTokenTransfers(address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {}
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * have been transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called after one token has been burned.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _afterTokenTransfers(address from, address to, uint256 startTokenId, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {}
          /**
           * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
           *
           * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
           * `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
           * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
           * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
           *
           * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
           */
          function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) private returns (bool) {
              try
                  ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data)
              returns (bytes4 retval) {
                  return retval == ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received.selector;
              } catch (bytes memory reason) {
                  if (reason.length == 0) {
                      _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                  }
                  assembly {
                      revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
                  }
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        MINT OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
              if (quantity == 0) _revert(MintZeroQuantity.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
              // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
              // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
              // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
                  // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  uint256 toMasked = uint256(uint160(to)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS;
                  if (toMasked == 0) _revert(MintToZeroAddress.selector);
                  uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
                  uint256 tokenId = startTokenId;
                  do {
                      assembly {
                          // Emit the `Transfer` event.
                          log4(
                              0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
                              0, // End of data (0, since no data).
                              _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
                              0, // `address(0)`.
                              toMasked, // `to`.
                              tokenId // `tokenId`.
                          )
                      }
                      // The `!=` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
                      // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
                  } while (++tokenId != end);
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = end;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
           *
           * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
           * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
           *
           * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
           * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
           * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
           * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
           */
          function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
              if (to == address(0)) _revert(MintToZeroAddress.selector);
              if (quantity == 0) _revert(MintZeroQuantity.selector);
              if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) _revert(MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
              // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
                  emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * See {_mint}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity, bytes memory _data) internal virtual {
              _mint(to, quantity);
              unchecked {
                  if (to.code.length != 0) {
                      uint256 end = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
                      uint256 index = end - quantity;
                      do {
                          if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
                              _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                          }
                      } while (index < end);
                      // Reentrancy protection.
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex != end) _revert(bytes4(0));
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
           */
          function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              _safeMint(to, quantity, "");
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                       APPROVAL OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_approve(to, tokenId, false)`.
           */
          function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _approve(to, tokenId, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
              address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
              if (approvalCheck && _msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
                      _revert(ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
                  }
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
              emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        BURN OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _burn(tokenId, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
              address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
              if (approvalCheck) {
                  // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
                  if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                      if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) _revert(TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
              }
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance -= 1`.
                  // - `numberBurned += 1`.
                  //
                  // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
                  // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the last owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
                  // - `burned` to `true`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      from,
                      (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
              emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
              // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
              unchecked {
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter++;
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                     EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
           */
          function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index];
              if (packed == 0) _revert(OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData.selector);
              uint256 extraDataCasted;
              // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  extraDataCasted := extraData
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
           * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
           *
           * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _extraData(address from, address to, uint24 previousExtraData) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
           * The returned result is shifted into position.
           */
          function _nextExtraData(address from, address to, uint256 prevOwnershipPacked) private view returns (uint256) {
              uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                       OTHER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
           *
           * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
           */
          function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
           */
          function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
              assembly {
                  // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
                  // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
                  // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
                  // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
                  let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
                  // Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
                  mstore(0x40, m)
                  // Assign the `str` to the end.
                  str := sub(m, 0x20)
                  // Zeroize the slot after the string.
                  mstore(str, 0)
                  // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
                  let end := str
                  // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
                  // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
                  // prettier-ignore
                  for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
                      str := sub(str, 1)
                      // Write the character to the pointer.
                      // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
                      mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
                      // Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
                      temp := div(temp, 10)
                      // prettier-ignore
                      if iszero(temp) { break }
                  }
                  let length := sub(end, str)
                  // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
                  str := sub(str, 0x20)
                  // Store the length.
                  mstore(str, length)
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev For more efficient reverts.
           */
          function _revert(bytes4 errorSelector) internal pure {
              assembly {
                  mstore(0x00, errorSelector)
                  revert(0x00, 0x04)
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable diamond facet contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
       * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
       * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
       * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
       *
       * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
       * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
       *
       * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
       * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
       */
      import { ERC721A__InitializableStorage } from "./ERC721A__InitializableStorage.sol";
      abstract contract ERC721A__Initializable {
          using ERC721A__InitializableStorage for ERC721A__InitializableStorage.Layout;
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice.
           */
          modifier initializerERC721A() {
              // If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple
              // inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the
              // contract may have been reentered.
              require(
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing
                      ? _isConstructor()
                      : !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized,
                  "ERC721A__Initializable: contract is already initialized"
              );
              bool isTopLevelCall = !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = true;
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized = true;
              }
              _;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = false;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
           * {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly.
           */
          modifier onlyInitializingERC721A() {
              require(
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing,
                  "ERC721A__Initializable: contract is not initializing"
              );
              _;
          }
          /// @dev Returns true if and only if the function is running in the constructor
          function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) {
              // extcodesize checks the size of the code stored in an address, and
              // address returns the current address. Since the code is still not
              // deployed when running a constructor, any checks on its code size will
              // yield zero, making it an effective way to detect if a contract is
              // under construction or not.
              address self = address(this);
              uint256 cs;
              assembly {
                  cs := extcodesize(self)
              }
              return cs == 0;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is a base storage for the  initialization function for upgradeable diamond facet contracts
       **/
      library ERC721A__InitializableStorage {
          struct Layout {
              /*
               * Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
               */
              bool _initialized;
              /*
               * Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
               */
              bool _initializing;
          }
          bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256("ERC721A.contracts.storage.initializable.facet");
          function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
              bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
              assembly {
                  l.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import "./IERC721AUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721AQueryable.
       */
      interface IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is IERC721AUpgradeable {
          /**
           * Invalid query range (`start` >= `stop`).
           */
          error InvalidQueryRange();
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
           *
           * - `addr = address(0)`
           * - `startTimestamp = 0`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = 0`
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is burned:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
           * - `burned = true`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
           *
           * Otherwise:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
           */
          function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (TokenOwnership memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
           * in the range [`start`, `stop`)
           * (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
           *
           * This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
           * grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `start < stop`
           */
          function tokensOfOwnerIn(address owner, uint256 start, uint256 stop) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
           * It is meant to be called off-chain.
           *
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
           * multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
           * an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
           */
          function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721A.
       */
      interface IERC721AUpgradeable {
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
           */
          error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
          /**
           * Cannot mint to the zero address.
           */
          error MintToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
           */
          error MintZeroQuantity();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token must be owned by `from`.
           */
          error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
          /**
           * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
           * ERC721Receiver interface.
           */
          error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
          /**
           * Cannot transfer to the zero address.
           */
          error TransferToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
           */
          error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
          /**
           * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
           */
          error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
          // =============================================================
          //                            STRUCTS
          // =============================================================
          struct TokenOwnership {
              // The address of the owner.
              address addr;
              // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
              uint64 startTimestamp;
              // Whether the token has been burned.
              bool burned;
              // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
              uint24 extraData;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                         TOKEN COUNTERS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC721
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
           * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
           * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
           * to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
           * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId, bytes calldata data) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
           * whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(address from, address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
          // =============================================================
          //                           IERC2309
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
           * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
           *
           * See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
           */
          event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IContractMetadata.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Contract Metadata
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `ContractMetadata` is a contract extension for any base contracts. It lets you set a metadata URI
       *           for you contract.
       *           Additionally, `ContractMetadata` is necessary for NFT contracts that want royalties to get distributed on OpenSea.
       */
      abstract contract ContractMetadata is IContractMetadata {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error ContractMetadataUnauthorized();
          /// @notice Returns the contract metadata URI.
          string public override contractURI;
          /**
           *  @notice         Lets a contract admin set the URI for contract-level metadata.
           *  @dev            Caller should be authorized to setup contractURI, e.g. contract admin.
           *                  See {_canSetContractURI}.
           *                  Emits {ContractURIUpdated Event}.
           *
           *  @param _uri     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           */
          function setContractURI(string memory _uri) external override {
              if (!_canSetContractURI()) {
                  revert ContractMetadataUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupContractURI(_uri);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set the URI for contract-level metadata.
          function _setupContractURI(string memory _uri) internal {
              string memory prevURI = contractURI;
              contractURI = _uri;
              emit ContractURIUpdated(prevURI, _uri);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether contract metadata can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetContractURI() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IDrop.sol";
      import "../lib/MerkleProof.sol";
      abstract contract Drop is IDrop {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error DropUnauthorized();
          /// @dev Exceeded the max token total supply
          error DropExceedMaxSupply();
          /// @dev No active claim condition
          error DropNoActiveCondition();
          /// @dev Claim condition invalid currency or price
          error DropClaimInvalidTokenPrice(
              address expectedCurrency,
              uint256 expectedPricePerToken,
              address actualCurrency,
              uint256 actualExpectedPricePerToken
          );
          /// @dev Claim condition exceeded limit
          error DropClaimExceedLimit(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          /// @dev Claim condition exceeded max supply
          error DropClaimExceedMaxSupply(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          /// @dev Claim condition not started yet
          error DropClaimNotStarted(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                                  State variables
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev The active conditions for claiming tokens.
          ClaimConditionList public claimCondition;
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                                  Drop logic
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Lets an account claim tokens.
          function claim(
              address _receiver,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof,
              bytes memory _data
          ) public payable virtual override {
              _beforeClaim(_receiver, _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken, _allowlistProof, _data);
              uint256 activeConditionId = getActiveClaimConditionId();
              verifyClaim(activeConditionId, _dropMsgSender(), _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken, _allowlistProof);
              // Update contract state.
              claimCondition.conditions[activeConditionId].supplyClaimed += _quantity;
              claimCondition.supplyClaimedByWallet[activeConditionId][_dropMsgSender()] += _quantity;
              // If there's a price, collect price.
              _collectPriceOnClaim(address(0), _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken);
              // Mint the relevant tokens to claimer.
              uint256 startTokenId = _transferTokensOnClaim(_receiver, _quantity);
              emit TokensClaimed(activeConditionId, _dropMsgSender(), _receiver, startTokenId, _quantity);
              _afterClaim(_receiver, _quantity, _currency, _pricePerToken, _allowlistProof, _data);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set claim conditions.
          function setClaimConditions(
              ClaimCondition[] calldata _conditions,
              bool _resetClaimEligibility
          ) external virtual override {
              if (!_canSetClaimConditions()) {
                  revert DropUnauthorized();
              }
              uint256 existingStartIndex = claimCondition.currentStartId;
              uint256 existingPhaseCount = claimCondition.count;
              /**
               *  The mapping `supplyClaimedByWallet` uses a claim condition's UID as a key.
               *
               *  If `_resetClaimEligibility == true`, we assign completely new UIDs to the claim
               *  conditions in `_conditions`, effectively resetting the restrictions on claims expressed
               *  by `supplyClaimedByWallet`.
               */
              uint256 newStartIndex = existingStartIndex;
              if (_resetClaimEligibility) {
                  newStartIndex = existingStartIndex + existingPhaseCount;
              }
              claimCondition.count = _conditions.length;
              claimCondition.currentStartId = newStartIndex;
              uint256 lastConditionStartTimestamp;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < _conditions.length; i++) {
                  require(i == 0 || lastConditionStartTimestamp < _conditions[i].startTimestamp, "ST");
                  uint256 supplyClaimedAlready = claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i].supplyClaimed;
                  if (supplyClaimedAlready > _conditions[i].maxClaimableSupply) {
                      revert DropExceedMaxSupply();
                  }
                  claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i] = _conditions[i];
                  claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i].supplyClaimed = supplyClaimedAlready;
                  lastConditionStartTimestamp = _conditions[i].startTimestamp;
              }
              /**
               *  Gas refunds (as much as possible)
               *
               *  If `_resetClaimEligibility == true`, we assign completely new UIDs to the claim
               *  conditions in `_conditions`. So, we delete claim conditions with UID < `newStartIndex`.
               *
               *  If `_resetClaimEligibility == false`, and there are more existing claim conditions
               *  than in `_conditions`, we delete the existing claim conditions that don't get replaced
               *  by the conditions in `_conditions`.
               */
              if (_resetClaimEligibility) {
                  for (uint256 i = existingStartIndex; i < newStartIndex; i++) {
                      delete claimCondition.conditions[i];
                  }
              } else {
                  if (existingPhaseCount > _conditions.length) {
                      for (uint256 i = _conditions.length; i < existingPhaseCount; i++) {
                          delete claimCondition.conditions[newStartIndex + i];
                      }
                  }
              }
              emit ClaimConditionsUpdated(_conditions, _resetClaimEligibility);
          }
          /// @dev Checks a request to claim NFTs against the active claim condition's criteria.
          function verifyClaim(
              uint256 _conditionId,
              address _claimer,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof
          ) public view virtual returns (bool isOverride) {
              ClaimCondition memory currentClaimPhase = claimCondition.conditions[_conditionId];
              uint256 claimLimit = currentClaimPhase.quantityLimitPerWallet;
              uint256 claimPrice = currentClaimPhase.pricePerToken;
              address claimCurrency = currentClaimPhase.currency;
              /*
               * Here `isOverride` implies that if the merkle proof verification fails,
               * the claimer would claim through open claim limit instead of allowlisted limit.
               */
              if (currentClaimPhase.merkleRoot != bytes32(0)) {
                  (isOverride, ) = MerkleProof.verify(
                      _allowlistProof.proof,
                      currentClaimPhase.merkleRoot,
                      keccak256(
                          abi.encodePacked(
                              _claimer,
                              _allowlistProof.quantityLimitPerWallet,
                              _allowlistProof.pricePerToken,
                              _allowlistProof.currency
                          )
                      )
                  );
              }
              if (isOverride) {
                  claimLimit = _allowlistProof.quantityLimitPerWallet != 0
                      ? _allowlistProof.quantityLimitPerWallet
                      : claimLimit;
                  claimPrice = _allowlistProof.pricePerToken != type(uint256).max
                      ? _allowlistProof.pricePerToken
                      : claimPrice;
                  claimCurrency = _allowlistProof.pricePerToken != type(uint256).max && _allowlistProof.currency != address(0)
                      ? _allowlistProof.currency
                      : claimCurrency;
              }
              uint256 supplyClaimedByWallet = claimCondition.supplyClaimedByWallet[_conditionId][_claimer];
              if (_currency != claimCurrency || _pricePerToken != claimPrice) {
                  revert DropClaimInvalidTokenPrice(_currency, _pricePerToken, claimCurrency, claimPrice);
              }
              if (_quantity == 0 || (_quantity + supplyClaimedByWallet > claimLimit)) {
                  revert DropClaimExceedLimit(claimLimit, _quantity + supplyClaimedByWallet);
              }
              if (currentClaimPhase.supplyClaimed + _quantity > currentClaimPhase.maxClaimableSupply) {
                  revert DropClaimExceedMaxSupply(
                      currentClaimPhase.maxClaimableSupply,
                      currentClaimPhase.supplyClaimed + _quantity
                  );
              }
              if (currentClaimPhase.startTimestamp > block.timestamp) {
                  revert DropClaimNotStarted(currentClaimPhase.startTimestamp, block.timestamp);
              }
          }
          /// @dev At any given moment, returns the uid for the active claim condition.
          function getActiveClaimConditionId() public view returns (uint256) {
              for (uint256 i = claimCondition.currentStartId + claimCondition.count; i > claimCondition.currentStartId; i--) {
                  if (block.timestamp >= claimCondition.conditions[i - 1].startTimestamp) {
                      return i - 1;
                  }
              }
              revert DropNoActiveCondition();
          }
          /// @dev Returns the claim condition at the given uid.
          function getClaimConditionById(uint256 _conditionId) external view returns (ClaimCondition memory condition) {
              condition = claimCondition.conditions[_conditionId];
          }
          /// @dev Returns the supply claimed by claimer for a given conditionId.
          function getSupplyClaimedByWallet(
              uint256 _conditionId,
              address _claimer
          ) public view returns (uint256 supplyClaimedByWallet) {
              supplyClaimedByWallet = claimCondition.supplyClaimedByWallet[_conditionId][_claimer];
          }
          /*////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
              Optional hooks that can be implemented in the derived contract
          ///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Exposes the ability to override the msg sender.
          function _dropMsgSender() internal virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          /// @dev Runs before every `claim` function call.
          function _beforeClaim(
              address _receiver,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof,
              bytes memory _data
          ) internal virtual {}
          /// @dev Runs after every `claim` function call.
          function _afterClaim(
              address _receiver,
              uint256 _quantity,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata _allowlistProof,
              bytes memory _data
          ) internal virtual {}
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
              Virtual functions: to be implemented in derived contract
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Collects and distributes the primary sale value of NFTs being claimed.
          function _collectPriceOnClaim(
              address _primarySaleRecipient,
              uint256 _quantityToClaim,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken
          ) internal virtual;
          /// @dev Transfers the NFTs being claimed.
          function _transferTokensOnClaim(
              address _to,
              uint256 _quantityBeingClaimed
          ) internal virtual returns (uint256 startTokenId);
          /// @dev Determine what wallet can update claim conditions
          function _canSetClaimConditions() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "../lib/Address.sol";
      import "./interface/IMulticall.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Provides a function to batch together multiple calls in a single external call.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       */
      contract Multicall is IMulticall {
          /**
           *  @notice Receives and executes a batch of function calls on this contract.
           *  @dev Receives and executes a batch of function calls on this contract.
           *
           *  @param data The bytes data that makes up the batch of function calls to execute.
           *  @return results The bytes data that makes up the result of the batch of function calls executed.
           */
          function multicall(bytes[] calldata data) external returns (bytes[] memory results) {
              results = new bytes[](data.length);
              address sender = _msgSender();
              bool isForwarder = msg.sender != sender;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < data.length; i++) {
                  if (isForwarder) {
                      results[i] = Address.functionDelegateCall(address(this), abi.encodePacked(data[i], sender));
                  } else {
                      results[i] = Address.functionDelegateCall(address(this), data[i]);
                  }
              }
              return results;
          }
          /// @notice Returns the sender in the given execution context.
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IOwnable.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Ownable
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `Ownable` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *           who the 'owner' of the inheriting smart contract is, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses
       *           information about who the contract's owner is.
       */
      abstract contract Ownable is IOwnable {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error OwnableUnauthorized();
          /// @dev Owner of the contract (purpose: OpenSea compatibility)
          address private _owner;
          /// @dev Reverts if caller is not the owner.
          modifier onlyOwner() {
              if (msg.sender != _owner) {
                  revert OwnableUnauthorized();
              }
              _;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Returns the owner of the contract.
           */
          function owner() public view override returns (address) {
              return _owner;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Lets an authorized wallet set a new owner for the contract.
           *  @param _newOwner The address to set as the new owner of the contract.
           */
          function setOwner(address _newOwner) external override {
              if (!_canSetOwner()) {
                  revert OwnableUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupOwner(_newOwner);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set a new owner for the contract. The new owner must be a contract admin.
          function _setupOwner(address _newOwner) internal {
              address _prevOwner = _owner;
              _owner = _newOwner;
              emit OwnerUpdated(_prevOwner, _newOwner);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether owner can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetOwner() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IPermissions.sol";
      import "../lib/Strings.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Permissions
       *  @dev     This contracts provides extending-contracts with role-based access control mechanisms
       */
      contract Permissions is IPermissions {
          /// @dev The `account` is missing a role.
          error PermissionsUnauthorizedAccount(address account, bytes32 neededRole);
          /// @dev The `account` already is a holder of `role`
          error PermissionsAlreadyGranted(address account, bytes32 role);
          /// @dev Invalid priviledge to revoke
          error PermissionsInvalidPermission(address expected, address actual);
          /// @dev Map from keccak256 hash of a role => a map from address => whether address has role.
          mapping(bytes32 => mapping(address => bool)) private _hasRole;
          /// @dev Map from keccak256 hash of a role to role admin. See {getRoleAdmin}.
          mapping(bytes32 => bytes32) private _getRoleAdmin;
          /// @dev Default admin role for all roles. Only accounts with this role can grant/revoke other roles.
          bytes32 public constant DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE = 0x00;
          /// @dev Modifier that checks if an account has the specified role; reverts otherwise.
          modifier onlyRole(bytes32 role) {
              _checkRole(role, msg.sender);
              _;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Checks whether an account has a particular role.
           *  @dev            Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account for which the role is being checked.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) public view override returns (bool) {
              return _hasRole[role][account];
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Checks whether an account has a particular role;
           *                  role restrictions can be swtiched on and off.
           *
           *  @dev            Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           *                  Role restrictions can be swtiched on and off:
           *                      - If address(0) has ROLE, then the ROLE restrictions
           *                        don't apply.
           *                      - If address(0) does not have ROLE, then the ROLE
           *                        restrictions will apply.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account for which the role is being checked.
           */
          function hasRoleWithSwitch(bytes32 role, address account) public view returns (bool) {
              if (!_hasRole[role][address(0)]) {
                  return _hasRole[role][account];
              }
              return true;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Returns the admin role that controls the specified role.
           *  @dev            See {grantRole} and {revokeRole}.
           *                  To change a role's admin, use {_setRoleAdmin}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view override returns (bytes32) {
              return _getRoleAdmin[role];
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Grants a role to an account, if not previously granted.
           *  @dev            Caller must have admin role for the `role`.
           *                  Emits {RoleGranted Event}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account to which the role is being granted.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              _checkRole(_getRoleAdmin[role], msg.sender);
              if (_hasRole[role][account]) {
                  revert PermissionsAlreadyGranted(account, role);
              }
              _setupRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Revokes role from an account.
           *  @dev            Caller must have admin role for the `role`.
           *                  Emits {RoleRevoked Event}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account from which the role is being revoked.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              _checkRole(_getRoleAdmin[role], msg.sender);
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Revokes role from the account.
           *  @dev            Caller must have the `role`, with caller being the same as `account`.
           *                  Emits {RoleRevoked Event}.
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param account  Address of the account from which the role is being revoked.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              if (msg.sender != account) {
                  revert PermissionsInvalidPermission(msg.sender, account);
              }
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /// @dev Sets `adminRole` as `role`'s admin role.
          function _setRoleAdmin(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) internal virtual {
              bytes32 previousAdminRole = _getRoleAdmin[role];
              _getRoleAdmin[role] = adminRole;
              emit RoleAdminChanged(role, previousAdminRole, adminRole);
          }
          /// @dev Sets up `role` for `account`
          function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              _hasRole[role][account] = true;
              emit RoleGranted(role, account, msg.sender);
          }
          /// @dev Revokes `role` from `account`
          function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              _checkRole(role, account);
              delete _hasRole[role][account];
              emit RoleRevoked(role, account, msg.sender);
          }
          /// @dev Checks `role` for `account`. Reverts with a message including the required role.
          function _checkRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal view virtual {
              if (!_hasRole[role][account]) {
                  revert PermissionsUnauthorizedAccount(account, role);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Checks `role` for `account`. Reverts with a message including the required role.
          function _checkRoleWithSwitch(bytes32 role, address account) internal view virtual {
              if (!hasRoleWithSwitch(role, account)) {
                  revert PermissionsUnauthorizedAccount(account, role);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IPermissionsEnumerable.sol";
      import "./Permissions.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   PermissionsEnumerable
       *  @dev     This contracts provides extending-contracts with role-based access control mechanisms.
       *           Also provides interfaces to view all members with a given role, and total count of members.
       */
      contract PermissionsEnumerable is IPermissionsEnumerable, Permissions {
          /**
           *  @notice A data structure to store data of members for a given role.
           *
           *  @param index    Current index in the list of accounts that have a role.
           *  @param members  map from index => address of account that has a role
           *  @param indexOf  map from address => index which the account has.
           */
          struct RoleMembers {
              uint256 index;
              mapping(uint256 => address) members;
              mapping(address => uint256) indexOf;
          }
          /// @dev map from keccak256 hash of a role to its members' data. See {RoleMembers}.
          mapping(bytes32 => RoleMembers) private roleMembers;
          /**
           *  @notice         Returns the role-member from a list of members for a role,
           *                  at a given index.
           *  @dev            Returns `member` who has `role`, at `index` of role-members list.
           *                  See struct {RoleMembers}, and mapping {roleMembers}
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *  @param index    Index in list of current members for the role.
           *
           *  @return member  Address of account that has `role`
           */
          function getRoleMember(bytes32 role, uint256 index) external view override returns (address member) {
              uint256 currentIndex = roleMembers[role].index;
              uint256 check;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < currentIndex; i += 1) {
                  if (roleMembers[role].members[i] != address(0)) {
                      if (check == index) {
                          member = roleMembers[role].members[i];
                          return member;
                      }
                      check += 1;
                  } else if (hasRole(role, address(0)) && i == roleMembers[role].indexOf[address(0)]) {
                      check += 1;
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Returns total number of accounts that have a role.
           *  @dev            Returns `count` of accounts that have `role`.
           *                  See struct {RoleMembers}, and mapping {roleMembers}
           *
           *  @param role     keccak256 hash of the role. e.g. keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE")
           *
           *  @return count   Total number of accounts that have `role`
           */
          function getRoleMemberCount(bytes32 role) external view override returns (uint256 count) {
              uint256 currentIndex = roleMembers[role].index;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < currentIndex; i += 1) {
                  if (roleMembers[role].members[i] != address(0)) {
                      count += 1;
                  }
              }
              if (hasRole(role, address(0))) {
                  count += 1;
              }
          }
          /// @dev Revokes `role` from `account`, and removes `account` from {roleMembers}
          ///      See {_removeMember}
          function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal override {
              super._revokeRole(role, account);
              _removeMember(role, account);
          }
          /// @dev Grants `role` to `account`, and adds `account` to {roleMembers}
          ///      See {_addMember}
          function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal override {
              super._setupRole(role, account);
              _addMember(role, account);
          }
          /// @dev adds `account` to {roleMembers}, for `role`
          function _addMember(bytes32 role, address account) internal {
              uint256 idx = roleMembers[role].index;
              roleMembers[role].index += 1;
              roleMembers[role].members[idx] = account;
              roleMembers[role].indexOf[account] = idx;
          }
          /// @dev removes `account` from {roleMembers}, for `role`
          function _removeMember(bytes32 role, address account) internal {
              uint256 idx = roleMembers[role].indexOf[account];
              delete roleMembers[role].members[idx];
              delete roleMembers[role].indexOf[account];
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IPrimarySale.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Primary Sale
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `PrimarySale` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *           the recipient of primary sales, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses information about
       *           primary sales, if desired.
       */
      abstract contract PrimarySale is IPrimarySale {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error PrimarySaleUnauthorized();
          /// @dev The recipient is invalid
          error PrimarySaleInvalidRecipient(address recipient);
          /// @dev The address that receives all primary sales value.
          address private recipient;
          /// @dev Returns primary sale recipient address.
          function primarySaleRecipient() public view override returns (address) {
              return recipient;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Updates primary sale recipient.
           *  @dev            Caller should be authorized to set primary sales info.
           *                  See {_canSetPrimarySaleRecipient}.
           *                  Emits {PrimarySaleRecipientUpdated Event}; See {_setupPrimarySaleRecipient}.
           *
           *  @param _saleRecipient   Address to be set as new recipient of primary sales.
           */
          function setPrimarySaleRecipient(address _saleRecipient) external override {
              if (!_canSetPrimarySaleRecipient()) {
                  revert PrimarySaleUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupPrimarySaleRecipient(_saleRecipient);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set the recipient for all primary sales.
          function _setupPrimarySaleRecipient(address _saleRecipient) internal {
              if (_saleRecipient == address(0)) {
                  revert PrimarySaleInvalidRecipient(_saleRecipient);
              }
              recipient = _saleRecipient;
              emit PrimarySaleRecipientUpdated(_saleRecipient);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether primary sale recipient can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetPrimarySaleRecipient() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./interface/IRoyalty.sol";
      /**
       *  @title   Royalty
       *  @notice  Thirdweb's `Royalty` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *           the recipient of royalty fee and the royalty fee basis points, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic
       *           that uses information about royalty fees, if desired.
       *
       *  @dev     The `Royalty` contract is ERC2981 compliant.
       */
      abstract contract Royalty is IRoyalty {
          /// @dev The sender is not authorized to perform the action
          error RoyaltyUnauthorized();
          /// @dev The recipient is invalid
          error RoyaltyInvalidRecipient(address recipient);
          /// @dev The fee bps exceeded the max value
          error RoyaltyExceededMaxFeeBps(uint256 max, uint256 actual);
          /// @dev The (default) address that receives all royalty value.
          address private royaltyRecipient;
          /// @dev The (default) % of a sale to take as royalty (in basis points).
          uint16 private royaltyBps;
          /// @dev Token ID => royalty recipient and bps for token
          mapping(uint256 => RoyaltyInfo) private royaltyInfoForToken;
          /**
           *  @notice   View royalty info for a given token and sale price.
           *  @dev      Returns royalty amount and recipient for `tokenId` and `salePrice`.
           *  @param tokenId          The tokenID of the NFT for which to query royalty info.
           *  @param salePrice        Sale price of the token.
           *
           *  @return receiver        Address of royalty recipient account.
           *  @return royaltyAmount   Royalty amount calculated at current royaltyBps value.
           */
          function royaltyInfo(
              uint256 tokenId,
              uint256 salePrice
          ) external view virtual override returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount) {
              (address recipient, uint256 bps) = getRoyaltyInfoForToken(tokenId);
              receiver = recipient;
              royaltyAmount = (salePrice * bps) / 10_000;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice          View royalty info for a given token.
           *  @dev             Returns royalty recipient and bps for `_tokenId`.
           *  @param _tokenId  The tokenID of the NFT for which to query royalty info.
           */
          function getRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 _tokenId) public view override returns (address, uint16) {
              RoyaltyInfo memory royaltyForToken = royaltyInfoForToken[_tokenId];
              return
                  royaltyForToken.recipient == address(0)
                      ? (royaltyRecipient, uint16(royaltyBps))
                      : (royaltyForToken.recipient, uint16(royaltyForToken.bps));
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Returns the defualt royalty recipient and BPS for this contract's NFTs.
           */
          function getDefaultRoyaltyInfo() external view override returns (address, uint16) {
              return (royaltyRecipient, uint16(royaltyBps));
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Updates default royalty recipient and bps.
           *  @dev            Caller should be authorized to set royalty info.
           *                  See {_canSetRoyaltyInfo}.
           *                  Emits {DefaultRoyalty Event}; See {_setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo}.
           *
           *  @param _royaltyRecipient   Address to be set as default royalty recipient.
           *  @param _royaltyBps         Updated royalty bps.
           */
          function setDefaultRoyaltyInfo(address _royaltyRecipient, uint256 _royaltyBps) external override {
              if (!_canSetRoyaltyInfo()) {
                  revert RoyaltyUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo(_royaltyRecipient, _royaltyBps);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin update the default royalty recipient and bps.
          function _setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo(address _royaltyRecipient, uint256 _royaltyBps) internal {
              if (_royaltyBps > 10_000) {
                  revert RoyaltyExceededMaxFeeBps(10_000, _royaltyBps);
              }
              royaltyRecipient = _royaltyRecipient;
              royaltyBps = uint16(_royaltyBps);
              emit DefaultRoyalty(_royaltyRecipient, _royaltyBps);
          }
          /**
           *  @notice         Updates default royalty recipient and bps for a particular token.
           *  @dev            Sets royalty info for `_tokenId`. Caller should be authorized to set royalty info.
           *                  See {_canSetRoyaltyInfo}.
           *                  Emits {RoyaltyForToken Event}; See {_setupRoyaltyInfoForToken}.
           *
           *  @param _recipient   Address to be set as royalty recipient for given token Id.
           *  @param _bps         Updated royalty bps for the token Id.
           */
          function setRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 _tokenId, address _recipient, uint256 _bps) external override {
              if (!_canSetRoyaltyInfo()) {
                  revert RoyaltyUnauthorized();
              }
              _setupRoyaltyInfoForToken(_tokenId, _recipient, _bps);
          }
          /// @dev Lets a contract admin set the royalty recipient and bps for a particular token Id.
          function _setupRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 _tokenId, address _recipient, uint256 _bps) internal {
              if (_bps > 10_000) {
                  revert RoyaltyExceededMaxFeeBps(10_000, _bps);
              }
              royaltyInfoForToken[_tokenId] = RoyaltyInfo({ recipient: _recipient, bps: _bps });
              emit RoyaltyForToken(_tokenId, _recipient, _bps);
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether royalty info can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetRoyaltyInfo() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.10;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "../lib/NFTMetadataRenderer.sol";
      import "./interface/ISharedMetadata.sol";
      import "../eip/interface/IERC4906.sol";
      abstract contract SharedMetadata is ISharedMetadata, IERC4906 {
          /// @notice Token metadata information
          SharedMetadataInfo public sharedMetadata;
          /// @notice Set shared metadata for NFTs
          function setSharedMetadata(SharedMetadataInfo calldata _metadata) external virtual {
              if (!_canSetSharedMetadata()) {
                  revert("Not authorized");
              }
              _setSharedMetadata(_metadata);
          }
          /**
           *  @dev Sets shared metadata for NFTs.
           *  @param _metadata common metadata for all tokens
           */
          function _setSharedMetadata(SharedMetadataInfo calldata _metadata) internal {
              sharedMetadata = SharedMetadataInfo({
                  name: _metadata.name,
                  description: _metadata.description,
                  imageURI: _metadata.imageURI,
                  animationURI: _metadata.animationURI
              });
              emit BatchMetadataUpdate(0, type(uint256).max);
              emit SharedMetadataUpdated({
                  name: _metadata.name,
                  description: _metadata.description,
                  imageURI: _metadata.imageURI,
                  animationURI: _metadata.animationURI
              });
          }
          /**
           *  @dev Token URI information getter
           *  @param tokenId Token ID to get URI for
           */
          function _getURIFromSharedMetadata(uint256 tokenId) internal view returns (string memory) {
              SharedMetadataInfo memory info = sharedMetadata;
              return
                  NFTMetadataRenderer.createMetadataEdition({
                      name: info.name,
                      description: info.description,
                      imageURI: info.imageURI,
                      animationURI: info.animationURI,
                      tokenOfEdition: tokenId
                  });
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether shared metadata can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetSharedMetadata() internal view virtual returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  The interface `IClaimCondition` is written for thirdweb's 'Drop' contracts, which are distribution mechanisms for tokens.
       *
       *  A claim condition defines criteria under which accounts can mint tokens. Claim conditions can be overwritten
       *  or added to by the contract admin. At any moment, there is only one active claim condition.
       */
      interface IClaimCondition {
          /**
           *  @notice The criteria that make up a claim condition.
           *
           *  @param startTimestamp                 The unix timestamp after which the claim condition applies.
           *                                        The same claim condition applies until the `startTimestamp`
           *                                        of the next claim condition.
           *
           *  @param maxClaimableSupply             The maximum total number of tokens that can be claimed under
           *                                        the claim condition.
           *
           *  @param supplyClaimed                  At any given point, the number of tokens that have been claimed
           *                                        under the claim condition.
           *
           *  @param quantityLimitPerWallet         The maximum number of tokens that can be claimed by a wallet.
           *
           *  @param merkleRoot                     The allowlist of addresses that can claim tokens under the claim
           *                                        condition.
           *
           *  @param pricePerToken                  The price required to pay per token claimed.
           *
           *  @param currency                       The currency in which the `pricePerToken` must be paid.
           *
           *  @param metadata                       Claim condition metadata.
           */
          struct ClaimCondition {
              uint256 startTimestamp;
              uint256 maxClaimableSupply;
              uint256 supplyClaimed;
              uint256 quantityLimitPerWallet;
              bytes32 merkleRoot;
              uint256 pricePerToken;
              address currency;
              string metadata;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./IClaimCondition.sol";
      /**
       *  The interface `IClaimConditionMultiPhase` is written for thirdweb's 'Drop' contracts, which are distribution mechanisms for tokens.
       *
       *  An authorized wallet can set a series of claim conditions, ordered by their respective `startTimestamp`.
       *  A claim condition defines criteria under which accounts can mint tokens. Claim conditions can be overwritten
       *  or added to by the contract admin. At any moment, there is only one active claim condition.
       */
      interface IClaimConditionMultiPhase is IClaimCondition {
          /**
           *  @notice The set of all claim conditions, at any given moment.
           *  Claim Phase ID = [currentStartId, currentStartId + length - 1];
           *
           *  @param currentStartId           The uid for the first claim condition amongst the current set of
           *                                  claim conditions. The uid for each next claim condition is one
           *                                  more than the previous claim condition's uid.
           *
           *  @param count                    The total number of phases / claim conditions in the list
           *                                  of claim conditions.
           *
           *  @param conditions                   The claim conditions at a given uid. Claim conditions
           *                                  are ordered in an ascending order by their `startTimestamp`.
           *
           *  @param supplyClaimedByWallet    Map from a claim condition uid and account to supply claimed by account.
           */
          struct ClaimConditionList {
              uint256 currentStartId;
              uint256 count;
              mapping(uint256 => ClaimCondition) conditions;
              mapping(uint256 => mapping(address => uint256)) supplyClaimedByWallet;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `ContractMetadata` is a contract extension for any base contracts. It lets you set a metadata URI
       *  for you contract.
       *
       *  Additionally, `ContractMetadata` is necessary for NFT contracts that want royalties to get distributed on OpenSea.
       */
      interface IContractMetadata {
          /// @dev Returns the metadata URI of the contract.
          function contractURI() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           *  @dev Sets contract URI for the storefront-level metadata of the contract.
           *       Only module admin can call this function.
           */
          function setContractURI(string calldata _uri) external;
          /// @dev Emitted when the contract URI is updated.
          event ContractURIUpdated(string prevURI, string newURI);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./IClaimConditionMultiPhase.sol";
      /**
       *  The interface `IDrop` is written for thirdweb's 'Drop' contracts, which are distribution mechanisms for tokens.
       *
       *  An authorized wallet can set a series of claim conditions, ordered by their respective `startTimestamp`.
       *  A claim condition defines criteria under which accounts can mint tokens. Claim conditions can be overwritten
       *  or added to by the contract admin. At any moment, there is only one active claim condition.
       */
      interface IDrop is IClaimConditionMultiPhase {
          /**
           *  @param proof Proof of concerned wallet's inclusion in an allowlist.
           *  @param quantityLimitPerWallet The total quantity of tokens the allowlisted wallet is eligible to claim over time.
           *  @param pricePerToken The price per token the allowlisted wallet must pay to claim tokens.
           *  @param currency The currency in which the allowlisted wallet must pay the price for claiming tokens.
           */
          struct AllowlistProof {
              bytes32[] proof;
              uint256 quantityLimitPerWallet;
              uint256 pricePerToken;
              address currency;
          }
          /// @notice Emitted when tokens are claimed via `claim`.
          event TokensClaimed(
              uint256 indexed claimConditionIndex,
              address indexed claimer,
              address indexed receiver,
              uint256 startTokenId,
              uint256 quantityClaimed
          );
          /// @notice Emitted when the contract's claim conditions are updated.
          event ClaimConditionsUpdated(ClaimCondition[] claimConditions, bool resetEligibility);
          /**
           *  @notice Lets an account claim a given quantity of NFTs.
           *
           *  @param receiver                       The receiver of the NFTs to claim.
           *  @param quantity                       The quantity of NFTs to claim.
           *  @param currency                       The currency in which to pay for the claim.
           *  @param pricePerToken                  The price per token to pay for the claim.
           *  @param allowlistProof                 The proof of the claimer's inclusion in the merkle root allowlist
           *                                        of the claim conditions that apply.
           *  @param data                           Arbitrary bytes data that can be leveraged in the implementation of this interface.
           */
          function claim(
              address receiver,
              uint256 quantity,
              address currency,
              uint256 pricePerToken,
              AllowlistProof calldata allowlistProof,
              bytes memory data
          ) external payable;
          /**
           *  @notice Lets a contract admin (account with `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE`) set claim conditions.
           *
           *  @param phases                   Claim conditions in ascending order by `startTimestamp`.
           *
           *  @param resetClaimEligibility    Whether to honor the restrictions applied to wallets who have claimed tokens in the current conditions,
           *                                  in the new claim conditions being set.
           *
           */
          function setClaimConditions(ClaimCondition[] calldata phases, bool resetClaimEligibility) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       * @dev Provides a function to batch together multiple calls in a single external call.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       */
      interface IMulticall {
          /**
           * @dev Receives and executes a batch of function calls on this contract.
           */
          function multicall(bytes[] calldata data) external returns (bytes[] memory results);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `Ownable` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *  who the 'owner' of the inheriting smart contract is, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses
       *  information about who the contract's owner is.
       */
      interface IOwnable {
          /// @dev Returns the owner of the contract.
          function owner() external view returns (address);
          /// @dev Lets a module admin set a new owner for the contract. The new owner must be a module admin.
          function setOwner(address _newOwner) external;
          /// @dev Emitted when a new Owner is set.
          event OwnerUpdated(address indexed prevOwner, address indexed newOwner);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       * @dev External interface of AccessControl declared to support ERC165 detection.
       */
      interface IPermissions {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `newAdminRole` is set as ``role``'s admin role, replacing `previousAdminRole`
           *
           * `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is the starting admin for all roles, despite
           * {RoleAdminChanged} not being emitted signaling this.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          event RoleAdminChanged(bytes32 indexed role, bytes32 indexed previousAdminRole, bytes32 indexed newAdminRole);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is granted `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call, an admin role
           * bearer except when using {AccessControl-_setupRole}.
           */
          event RoleGranted(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is revoked `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call:
           *   - if using `revokeRole`, it is the admin role bearer
           *   - if using `renounceRole`, it is the role bearer (i.e. `account`)
           */
          event RoleRevoked(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) external view returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
           * {revokeRole}.
           *
           * To change a role's admin, use {AccessControl-_setRoleAdmin}.
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view returns (bytes32);
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
           *
           * Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
           * purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
           * if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
           *
           * If the calling account had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must be `account`.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "./IPermissions.sol";
      /**
       * @dev External interface of AccessControlEnumerable declared to support ERC165 detection.
       */
      interface IPermissionsEnumerable is IPermissions {
          /**
           * @dev Returns one of the accounts that have `role`. `index` must be a
           * value between 0 and {getRoleMemberCount}, non-inclusive.
           *
           * Role bearers are not sorted in any particular way, and their ordering may
           * change at any point.
           *
           * WARNING: When using {getRoleMember} and {getRoleMemberCount}, make sure
           * you perform all queries on the same block. See the following
           * [forum post](https://forum.openzeppelin.com/t/iterating-over-elements-on-enumerableset-in-openzeppelin-contracts/2296)
           * for more information.
           */
          function getRoleMember(bytes32 role, uint256 index) external view returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of accounts that have `role`. Can be used
           * together with {getRoleMember} to enumerate all bearers of a role.
           */
          function getRoleMemberCount(bytes32 role) external view returns (uint256);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `Primary` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *  the recipient of primary sales, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic that uses information about
       *  primary sales, if desired.
       */
      interface IPrimarySale {
          /// @dev The adress that receives all primary sales value.
          function primarySaleRecipient() external view returns (address);
          /// @dev Lets a module admin set the default recipient of all primary sales.
          function setPrimarySaleRecipient(address _saleRecipient) external;
          /// @dev Emitted when a new sale recipient is set.
          event PrimarySaleRecipientUpdated(address indexed recipient);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      import "../../eip/interface/IERC2981.sol";
      /**
       *  Thirdweb's `Royalty` is a contract extension to be used with any base contract. It exposes functions for setting and reading
       *  the recipient of royalty fee and the royalty fee basis points, and lets the inheriting contract perform conditional logic
       *  that uses information about royalty fees, if desired.
       *
       *  The `Royalty` contract is ERC2981 compliant.
       */
      interface IRoyalty is IERC2981 {
          struct RoyaltyInfo {
              address recipient;
              uint256 bps;
          }
          /// @dev Returns the royalty recipient and fee bps.
          function getDefaultRoyaltyInfo() external view returns (address, uint16);
          /// @dev Lets a module admin update the royalty bps and recipient.
          function setDefaultRoyaltyInfo(address _royaltyRecipient, uint256 _royaltyBps) external;
          /// @dev Lets a module admin set the royalty recipient for a particular token Id.
          function setRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 tokenId, address recipient, uint256 bps) external;
          /// @dev Returns the royalty recipient for a particular token Id.
          function getRoyaltyInfoForToken(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address, uint16);
          /// @dev Emitted when royalty info is updated.
          event DefaultRoyalty(address indexed newRoyaltyRecipient, uint256 newRoyaltyBps);
          /// @dev Emitted when royalty recipient for tokenId is set
          event RoyaltyForToken(uint256 indexed tokenId, address indexed royaltyRecipient, uint256 royaltyBps);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.10;
      /// @author thirdweb
      interface ISharedMetadata {
          /// @notice Emitted when shared metadata is lazy minted.
          event SharedMetadataUpdated(string name, string description, string imageURI, string animationURI);
          /**
           *  @notice Structure for metadata shared across all tokens
           *
           *  @param name Shared name of NFT in metadata
           *  @param description Shared description of NFT in metadata
           *  @param imageURI Shared URI of image to render for NFTs
           *  @param animationURI Shared URI of animation to render for NFTs
           */
          struct SharedMetadataInfo {
              string name;
              string description;
              string imageURI;
              string animationURI;
          }
          /**
           *  @notice Set shared metadata for NFTs
           *  @param _metadata common metadata for all tokens
           */
          function setSharedMetadata(SharedMetadataInfo calldata _metadata) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.0 (metatx/ERC2771Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.11;
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Context variant with ERC2771 support.
       */
      abstract contract ERC2771ContextUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
          mapping(address => bool) private _trustedForwarder;
          function __ERC2771Context_init(address[] memory trustedForwarder) internal onlyInitializing {
              __Context_init_unchained();
              __ERC2771Context_init_unchained(trustedForwarder);
          }
          function __ERC2771Context_init_unchained(address[] memory trustedForwarder) internal onlyInitializing {
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < trustedForwarder.length; i++) {
                  _trustedForwarder[trustedForwarder[i]] = true;
              }
          }
          function isTrustedForwarder(address forwarder) public view virtual returns (bool) {
              return _trustedForwarder[forwarder];
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual override returns (address sender) {
              if (isTrustedForwarder(msg.sender)) {
                  // The assembly code is more direct than the Solidity version using `abi.decode`.
                  assembly {
                      sender := shr(96, calldataload(sub(calldatasize(), 20)))
                  }
              } else {
                  return super._msgSender();
              }
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual override returns (bytes calldata) {
              if (isTrustedForwarder(msg.sender)) {
                  return msg.data[:msg.data.length - 20];
              } else {
                  return super._msgData();
              }
          }
          uint256[49] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../../../../../eip/interface/IERC20.sol";
      import { Address } from "../../../../../lib/Address.sol";
      /**
       * @title SafeERC20
       * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
       * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
       * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
       * successful.
       * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
       * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
       */
      library SafeERC20 {
          using Address for address;
          function safeTransfer(IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value) internal {
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
          }
          function safeTransferFrom(IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value) internal {
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
           * {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
           *
           * Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
           * {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
           */
          function safeApprove(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
              // safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
              // or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
              // 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
              require(
                  (value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
                  "SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
              );
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value));
          }
          function safeIncreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
              uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender) + value;
              _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
          }
          function safeDecreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 oldAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender);
                  require(oldAllowance >= value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero");
                  uint256 newAllowance = oldAllowance - value;
                  _callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
           * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
           * @param token The token targeted by the call.
           * @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
           */
          function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20 token, bytes memory data) private {
              // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
              // we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address.functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
              // the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
              bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed");
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // Return data is optional
                  require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed");
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Base64.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Provides a set of functions to operate with Base64 strings.
       *
       * _Available since v4.5._
       */
      library Base64 {
          /**
           * @dev Base64 Encoding/Decoding Table
           */
          string internal constant _TABLE = "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789+/";
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `bytes` to its Bytes64 `string` representation.
           */
          function encode(bytes memory data) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              /**
               * Inspired by Brecht Devos (Brechtpd) implementation - MIT licence
               * https://github.com/Brechtpd/base64/blob/e78d9fd951e7b0977ddca77d92dc85183770daf4/base64.sol
               */
              if (data.length == 0) return "";
              // Loads the table into memory
              string memory table = _TABLE;
              // Encoding takes 3 bytes chunks of binary data from `bytes` data parameter
              // and split into 4 numbers of 6 bits.
              // The final Base64 length should be `bytes` data length multiplied by 4/3 rounded up
              // - `data.length + 2`  -> Round up
              // - `/ 3`              -> Number of 3-bytes chunks
              // - `4 *`              -> 4 characters for each chunk
              string memory result = new string(4 * ((data.length + 2) / 3));
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  // Prepare the lookup table (skip the first "length" byte)
                  let tablePtr := add(table, 1)
                  // Prepare result pointer, jump over length
                  let resultPtr := add(result, 32)
                  // Run over the input, 3 bytes at a time
                  for {
                      let dataPtr := data
                      let endPtr := add(data, mload(data))
                  } lt(dataPtr, endPtr) {
                  } {
                      // Advance 3 bytes
                      dataPtr := add(dataPtr, 3)
                      let input := mload(dataPtr)
                      // To write each character, shift the 3 bytes (18 bits) chunk
                      // 4 times in blocks of 6 bits for each character (18, 12, 6, 0)
                      // and apply logical AND with 0x3F which is the number of
                      // the previous character in the ASCII table prior to the Base64 Table
                      // The result is then added to the table to get the character to write,
                      // and finally write it in the result pointer but with a left shift
                      // of 256 (1 byte) - 8 (1 ASCII char) = 248 bits
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(shr(18, input), 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(shr(12, input), 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(shr(6, input), 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                      mstore8(resultPtr, mload(add(tablePtr, and(input, 0x3F))))
                      resultPtr := add(resultPtr, 1) // Advance
                  }
                  // When data `bytes` is not exactly 3 bytes long
                  // it is padded with `=` characters at the end
                  switch mod(mload(data), 3)
                  case 1 {
                      mstore8(sub(resultPtr, 1), 0x3d)
                      mstore8(sub(resultPtr, 2), 0x3d)
                  }
                  case 2 {
                      mstore8(sub(resultPtr, 1), 0x3d)
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      interface IWETH {
          function deposit() external payable;
          function withdraw(uint256 amount) external;
          function transfer(address to, uint256 value) external returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /// @author thirdweb, OpenZeppelin Contracts (v4.9.0)
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           *
           * Furthermore, `isContract` will also return true if the target contract within
           * the same transaction is already scheduled for destruction by `SELFDESTRUCT`,
           * which only has an effect at the end of a transaction.
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://consensys.net/diligence/blog/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.8.0/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
           * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
           *
           * _Available since v4.8._
           */
          function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
              address target,
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  if (returndata.length == 0) {
                      // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
                      // otherwise we already know that it was a contract
                      require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
                  }
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason or using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
              // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                      revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                  }
              } else {
                  revert(errorMessage);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      // Helper interfaces
      import { IWETH } from "../infra/interface/IWETH.sol";
      import { SafeERC20, IERC20 } from "../external-deps/openzeppelin/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol";
      library CurrencyTransferLib {
          using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
          error CurrencyTransferLibMismatchedValue(uint256 expected, uint256 actual);
          error CurrencyTransferLibFailedNativeTransfer(address recipient, uint256 value);
          /// @dev The address interpreted as native token of the chain.
          address public constant NATIVE_TOKEN = 0xEeeeeEeeeEeEeeEeEeEeeEEEeeeeEeeeeeeeEEeE;
          /// @dev Transfers a given amount of currency.
          function transferCurrency(address _currency, address _from, address _to, uint256 _amount) internal {
              if (_amount == 0) {
                  return;
              }
              if (_currency == NATIVE_TOKEN) {
                  safeTransferNativeToken(_to, _amount);
              } else {
                  safeTransferERC20(_currency, _from, _to, _amount);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfers a given amount of currency. (With native token wrapping)
          function transferCurrencyWithWrapper(
              address _currency,
              address _from,
              address _to,
              uint256 _amount,
              address _nativeTokenWrapper
          ) internal {
              if (_amount == 0) {
                  return;
              }
              if (_currency == NATIVE_TOKEN) {
                  if (_from == address(this)) {
                      // withdraw from weth then transfer withdrawn native token to recipient
                      IWETH(_nativeTokenWrapper).withdraw(_amount);
                      safeTransferNativeTokenWithWrapper(_to, _amount, _nativeTokenWrapper);
                  } else if (_to == address(this)) {
                      // store native currency in weth
                      if (_amount != msg.value) {
                          revert CurrencyTransferLibMismatchedValue(msg.value, _amount);
                      }
                      IWETH(_nativeTokenWrapper).deposit{ value: _amount }();
                  } else {
                      safeTransferNativeTokenWithWrapper(_to, _amount, _nativeTokenWrapper);
                  }
              } else {
                  safeTransferERC20(_currency, _from, _to, _amount);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfer `amount` of ERC20 token from `from` to `to`.
          function safeTransferERC20(address _currency, address _from, address _to, uint256 _amount) internal {
              if (_from == _to) {
                  return;
              }
              if (_from == address(this)) {
                  IERC20(_currency).safeTransfer(_to, _amount);
              } else {
                  IERC20(_currency).safeTransferFrom(_from, _to, _amount);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfers `amount` of native token to `to`.
          function safeTransferNativeToken(address to, uint256 value) internal {
              // solhint-disable avoid-low-level-calls
              // slither-disable-next-line low-level-calls
              (bool success, ) = to.call{ value: value }("");
              if (!success) {
                  revert CurrencyTransferLibFailedNativeTransfer(to, value);
              }
          }
          /// @dev Transfers `amount` of native token to `to`. (With native token wrapping)
          function safeTransferNativeTokenWithWrapper(address to, uint256 value, address _nativeTokenWrapper) internal {
              // solhint-disable avoid-low-level-calls
              // slither-disable-next-line low-level-calls
              (bool success, ) = to.call{ value: value }("");
              if (!success) {
                  IWETH(_nativeTokenWrapper).deposit{ value: value }();
                  IERC20(_nativeTokenWrapper).safeTransfer(to, value);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache 2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author OpenZeppelin, thirdweb
      library MerkleProof {
          function verify(bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 root, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
              bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
              uint256 index = 0;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
                  index *= 2;
                  bytes32 proofElement = proof[i];
                  if (computedHash <= proofElement) {
                      // Hash(current computed hash + current element of the proof)
                      computedHash = _efficientHash(computedHash, proofElement);
                  } else {
                      // Hash(current element of the proof + current computed hash)
                      computedHash = _efficientHash(proofElement, computedHash);
                      index += 1;
                  }
              }
              // Check if the computed hash (root) is equal to the provided root
              return (computedHash == root, index);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Implementation of keccak256(abi.encode(a, b)) that doesn't allocate or expand memory.
           */
          function _efficientHash(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32 value) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  mstore(0x00, a)
                  mstore(0x20, b)
                  value := keccak256(0x00, 0x40)
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /* solhint-disable quotes */
      /// @author thirdweb
      /// credits: Zora
      import "./Strings.sol";
      import "../external-deps/openzeppelin/utils/Base64.sol";
      /// NFT metadata library for rendering metadata associated with editions
      library NFTMetadataRenderer {
          /**
           *  @notice Generate edition metadata from storage information as base64-json blob
           *  @dev Combines the media data and metadata
           * @param name Name of NFT in metadata
           * @param description Description of NFT in metadata
           * @param imageURI URI of image to render for edition
           * @param animationURI URI of animation to render for edition
           * @param tokenOfEdition Token ID for specific token
           */
          function createMetadataEdition(
              string memory name,
              string memory description,
              string memory imageURI,
              string memory animationURI,
              uint256 tokenOfEdition
          ) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              string memory _tokenMediaData = tokenMediaData(imageURI, animationURI);
              bytes memory json = createMetadataJSON(name, description, _tokenMediaData, tokenOfEdition);
              return encodeMetadataJSON(json);
          }
          /**
           * @param name Name of NFT in metadata
           * @param description Description of NFT in metadata
           * @param mediaData Data for media to include in json object
           * @param tokenOfEdition Token ID for specific token
           */
          function createMetadataJSON(
              string memory name,
              string memory description,
              string memory mediaData,
              uint256 tokenOfEdition
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              return
                  abi.encodePacked(
                      '{"name": "',
                      name,
                      " ",
                      Strings.toString(tokenOfEdition),
                      '", "',
                      'description": "',
                      description,
                      '", "',
                      mediaData,
                      'properties": {"number": ',
                      Strings.toString(tokenOfEdition),
                      ', "name": "',
                      name,
                      '"}}'
                  );
          }
          /// Encodes the argument json bytes into base64-data uri format
          /// @param json Raw json to base64 and turn into a data-uri
          function encodeMetadataJSON(bytes memory json) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return string(abi.encodePacked("data:application/json;base64,", Base64.encode(json)));
          }
          /// Generates edition metadata from storage information as base64-json blob
          /// Combines the media data and metadata
          /// @param imageUrl URL of image to render for edition
          /// @param animationUrl URL of animation to render for edition
          function tokenMediaData(string memory imageUrl, string memory animationUrl) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bool hasImage = bytes(imageUrl).length > 0;
              bool hasAnimation = bytes(animationUrl).length > 0;
              if (hasImage && hasAnimation) {
                  return string(abi.encodePacked('image": "', imageUrl, '", "animation_url": "', animationUrl, '", "'));
              }
              if (hasImage) {
                  return string(abi.encodePacked('image": "', imageUrl, '", "'));
              }
              if (hasAnimation) {
                  return string(abi.encodePacked('animation_url": "', animationUrl, '", "'));
              }
              return "";
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /// @author thirdweb
      /**
       * @dev String operations.
       */
      library Strings {
          bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              // Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
              // https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
              if (value == 0) {
                  return "0";
              }
              uint256 temp = value;
              uint256 digits;
              while (temp != 0) {
                  digits++;
                  temp /= 10;
              }
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
              while (value != 0) {
                  digits -= 1;
                  buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
                  value /= 10;
              }
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              if (value == 0) {
                  return "0x00";
              }
              uint256 temp = value;
              uint256 length = 0;
              while (temp != 0) {
                  length++;
                  temp >>= 8;
              }
              return toHexString(value, length);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
              buffer[0] = "0";
              buffer[1] = "x";
              for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
                  buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
                  value >>= 4;
              }
              require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hexadecimal representation of `value`.
          /// The output is prefixed with "0x", encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte,
          /// and the alphabets are capitalized conditionally according to
          /// https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-55
          function toHexStringChecksummed(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              str = toHexString(value);
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let mask := shl(6, div(not(0), 255)) // `0b010000000100000000 ...`
                  let o := add(str, 0x22)
                  let hashed := and(keccak256(o, 40), mul(34, mask)) // `0b10001000 ... `
                  let t := shl(240, 136) // `0b10001000 << 240`
                  for {
                      let i := 0
                  } 1 {
                  } {
                      mstore(add(i, i), mul(t, byte(i, hashed)))
                      i := add(i, 1)
                      if eq(i, 20) {
                          break
                      }
                  }
                  mstore(o, xor(mload(o), shr(1, and(mload(0x00), and(mload(o), mask)))))
                  o := add(o, 0x20)
                  mstore(o, xor(mload(o), shr(1, and(mload(0x20), and(mload(o), mask)))))
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hexadecimal representation of `value`.
          /// The output is prefixed with "0x" and encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexString(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              str = toHexStringNoPrefix(value);
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let strLength := add(mload(str), 2) // Compute the length.
                  mstore(str, 0x3078) // Write the "0x" prefix.
                  str := sub(str, 2) // Move the pointer.
                  mstore(str, strLength) // Write the length.
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hexadecimal representation of `value`.
          /// The output is encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexStringNoPrefix(address value) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  str := mload(0x40)
                  // Allocate the memory.
                  // We need 0x20 bytes for the trailing zeros padding, 0x20 bytes for the length,
                  // 0x02 bytes for the prefix, and 0x28 bytes for the digits.
                  // The next multiple of 0x20 above (0x20 + 0x20 + 0x02 + 0x28) is 0x80.
                  mstore(0x40, add(str, 0x80))
                  // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space.
                  mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566)
                  str := add(str, 2)
                  mstore(str, 40)
                  let o := add(str, 0x20)
                  mstore(add(o, 40), 0)
                  value := shl(96, value)
                  // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
                  // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
                  for {
                      let i := 0
                  } 1 {
                  } {
                      let p := add(o, add(i, i))
                      let temp := byte(i, value)
                      mstore8(add(p, 1), mload(and(temp, 15)))
                      mstore8(p, mload(shr(4, temp)))
                      i := add(i, 1)
                      if eq(i, 20) {
                          break
                      }
                  }
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hex encoded string from the raw bytes.
          /// The output is encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexString(bytes memory raw) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              str = toHexStringNoPrefix(raw);
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let strLength := add(mload(str), 2) // Compute the length.
                  mstore(str, 0x3078) // Write the "0x" prefix.
                  str := sub(str, 2) // Move the pointer.
                  mstore(str, strLength) // Write the length.
              }
          }
          /// @dev Returns the hex encoded string from the raw bytes.
          /// The output is encoded using 2 hexadecimal digits per byte.
          function toHexStringNoPrefix(bytes memory raw) internal pure returns (string memory str) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  let length := mload(raw)
                  str := add(mload(0x40), 2) // Skip 2 bytes for the optional prefix.
                  mstore(str, add(length, length)) // Store the length of the output.
                  // Store "0123456789abcdef" in scratch space.
                  mstore(0x0f, 0x30313233343536373839616263646566)
                  let o := add(str, 0x20)
                  let end := add(raw, length)
                  for {
                  } iszero(eq(raw, end)) {
                  } {
                      raw := add(raw, 1)
                      mstore8(add(o, 1), mload(and(mload(raw), 15)))
                      mstore8(o, mload(and(shr(4, mload(raw)), 15)))
                      o := add(o, 2)
                  }
                  mstore(o, 0) // Zeroize the slot after the string.
                  mstore(0x40, add(o, 0x20)) // Allocate the memory.
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0
      pragma solidity ^0.8.11;
      /// @author thirdweb
      //   $$\\     $$\\       $$\\                 $$\\                         $$\\
      //   $$ |    $$ |      \\__|                $$ |                        $$ |
      // $$$$$$\\   $$$$$$$\\  $$\\  $$$$$$\\   $$$$$$$ |$$\\  $$\\  $$\\  $$$$$$\\  $$$$$$$\\
      // \\_$$  _|  $$  __$$\\ $$ |$$  __$$\\ $$  __$$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$  __$$\\ $$  __$$\\
      //   $$ |    $$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |  \\__|$$ /  $$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$$$$$$$ |$$ |  $$ |
      //   $$ |$$\\ $$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |      $$ |  $$ |$$ | $$ | $$ |$$   ____|$$ |  $$ |
      //   \\$$$$  |$$ |  $$ |$$ |$$ |      \\$$$$$$$ |\\$$$$$\\$$$$  |\\$$$$$$$\\ $$$$$$$  |
      //    \\____/ \\__|  \\__|\\__|\\__|       \\_______| \\_____\\____/  \\_______|\\_______/
      //  ==========  External imports    ==========
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/utils/StringsUpgradeable.sol";
      import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/interfaces/IERC2981Upgradeable.sol";
      import "../../eip/queryable/ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol";
      //  ==========  Internal imports    ==========
      import "../../external-deps/openzeppelin/metatx/ERC2771ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../../lib/CurrencyTransferLib.sol";
      //  ==========  Features    ==========
      import "../../extension/Multicall.sol";
      import "../../extension/ContractMetadata.sol";
      import "../../extension/Royalty.sol";
      import "../../extension/PrimarySale.sol";
      import "../../extension/Ownable.sol";
      import "../../extension/SharedMetadata.sol";
      import "../../extension/PermissionsEnumerable.sol";
      import "../../extension/Drop.sol";
      contract OpenEditionERC721 is
          Initializable,
          ContractMetadata,
          Royalty,
          PrimarySale,
          Ownable,
          SharedMetadata,
          PermissionsEnumerable,
          Drop,
          ERC2771ContextUpgradeable,
          Multicall,
          ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable
      {
          using StringsUpgradeable for uint256;
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                                  State variables
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Only transfers to or from TRANSFER_ROLE holders are valid, when transfers are restricted.
          bytes32 private transferRole;
          /// @dev Only MINTER_ROLE holders can update the shared metadata of tokens.
          bytes32 private minterRole;
          /// @dev Max bps in the thirdweb system.
          uint256 private constant MAX_BPS = 10_000;
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                          Constructor + initializer logic
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          constructor() initializer {}
          /// @dev Initializes the contract, like a constructor.
          function initialize(
              address _defaultAdmin,
              string memory _name,
              string memory _symbol,
              string memory _contractURI,
              address[] memory _trustedForwarders,
              address _saleRecipient,
              address _royaltyRecipient,
              uint128 _royaltyBps
          ) external initializerERC721A initializer {
              bytes32 _transferRole = keccak256("TRANSFER_ROLE");
              bytes32 _minterRole = keccak256("MINTER_ROLE");
              // Initialize inherited contracts, most base-like -> most derived.
              __ERC2771Context_init(_trustedForwarders);
              __ERC721A_init(_name, _symbol);
              _setupContractURI(_contractURI);
              _setupOwner(_defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(_minterRole, _defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(_transferRole, _defaultAdmin);
              _setupRole(_transferRole, address(0));
              _setupDefaultRoyaltyInfo(_royaltyRecipient, _royaltyBps);
              _setupPrimarySaleRecipient(_saleRecipient);
              transferRole = _transferRole;
              minterRole = _minterRole;
          }
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                              ERC 165 / 721 / 2981 logic
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Returns the URI for a given tokenId.
          function tokenURI(
              uint256 _tokenId
          ) public view virtual override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable) returns (string memory) {
              if (!_exists(_tokenId)) {
                  revert("!ID");
              }
              return _getURIFromSharedMetadata(_tokenId);
          }
          /// @dev See ERC 165
          function supportsInterface(
              bytes4 interfaceId
          ) public view virtual override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC165, IERC721AUpgradeable) returns (bool) {
              return super.supportsInterface(interfaceId) || type(IERC2981Upgradeable).interfaceId == interfaceId;
          }
          /// @dev The start token ID for the contract.
          function _startTokenId() internal pure override returns (uint256) {
              return 1;
          }
          function startTokenId() public pure returns (uint256) {
              return _startTokenId();
          }
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                              Internal functions
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /// @dev Collects and distributes the primary sale value of NFTs being claimed.
          function _collectPriceOnClaim(
              address _primarySaleRecipient,
              uint256 _quantityToClaim,
              address _currency,
              uint256 _pricePerToken
          ) internal override {
              if (_pricePerToken == 0) {
                  require(msg.value == 0, "!Value");
                  return;
              }
              uint256 totalPrice = _quantityToClaim * _pricePerToken;
              bool validMsgValue;
              if (_currency == CurrencyTransferLib.NATIVE_TOKEN) {
                  validMsgValue = msg.value == totalPrice;
              } else {
                  validMsgValue = msg.value == 0;
              }
              require(validMsgValue, "!V");
              address saleRecipient = _primarySaleRecipient == address(0) ? primarySaleRecipient() : _primarySaleRecipient;
              CurrencyTransferLib.transferCurrency(_currency, _msgSender(), saleRecipient, totalPrice);
          }
          /// @dev Transfers the NFTs being claimed.
          function _transferTokensOnClaim(
              address _to,
              uint256 _quantityBeingClaimed
          ) internal override returns (uint256 startTokenId_) {
              startTokenId_ = _nextTokenId();
              _safeMint(_to, _quantityBeingClaimed);
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether primary sale recipient can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetPrimarySaleRecipient() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether owner can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetOwner() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether royalty info can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetRoyaltyInfo() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether contract metadata can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetContractURI() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Checks whether platform fee info can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetClaimConditions() internal view override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, _msgSender());
          }
          /// @dev Returns whether the shared metadata of tokens can be set in the given execution context.
          function _canSetSharedMetadata() internal view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(minterRole, _msgSender());
          }
          /*///////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
                              Miscellaneous
          //////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////*/
          /**
           * Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
           */
          function totalMinted() external view returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  return _nextTokenId() - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /// @dev The tokenId of the next NFT that will be minted / lazy minted.
          function nextTokenIdToMint() external view returns (uint256) {
              return _nextTokenId();
          }
          /// @dev The next token ID of the NFT that can be claimed.
          function nextTokenIdToClaim() external view returns (uint256) {
              return _nextTokenId();
          }
          /// @dev Burns `tokenId`. See {ERC721-_burn}.
          function burn(uint256 tokenId) external virtual {
              // note: ERC721AUpgradeable's `_burn(uint256,bool)` internally checks for token approvals.
              _burn(tokenId, true);
          }
          /// @dev See {ERC721-_beforeTokenTransfer}.
          function _beforeTokenTransfers(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 startTokenId_,
              uint256 quantity
          ) internal virtual override {
              super._beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, startTokenId_, quantity);
              // if transfer is restricted on the contract, we still want to allow burning and minting
              if (!hasRole(transferRole, address(0)) && from != address(0) && to != address(0)) {
                  if (!hasRole(transferRole, from) && !hasRole(transferRole, to)) {
                      revert("!T");
                  }
              }
          }
          function _dropMsgSender() internal view virtual override returns (address) {
              return _msgSender();
          }
          function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual override returns (address) {
              return _msgSender();
          }
          function _msgSender()
              internal
              view
              virtual
              override(ERC2771ContextUpgradeable, Multicall)
              returns (address sender)
          {
              return ERC2771ContextUpgradeable._msgSender();
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (interfaces/IERC2981.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../utils/introspection/IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard.
       *
       * A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal
       * support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants.
       *
       * _Available since v4.5._
       */
      interface IERC2981Upgradeable is IERC165Upgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of
           * exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be paid in that same unit of exchange.
           */
          function royaltyInfo(
              uint256 tokenId,
              uint256 salePrice
          ) external view returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
       * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
       * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
       * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
       *
       * The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be
       * reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in
       * case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized.
       *
       * For example:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```solidity
       * contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable {
       *     function initialize() initializer public {
       *         __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK");
       *     }
       * }
       *
       * contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable {
       *     function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public {
       *         __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken");
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
       * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
       *
       * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
       * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
       *
       * [CAUTION]
       * ====
       * Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized.
       *
       * An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation
       * contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke
       * the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```
       * /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
       * constructor() {
       *     _disableInitializers();
       * }
       * ```
       * ====
       */
      abstract contract Initializable {
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
           * @custom:oz-retyped-from bool
           */
          uint8 private _initialized;
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
           */
          bool private _initializing;
          /**
           * @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized.
           */
          event Initialized(uint8 version);
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope,
           * `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a
           * constructor.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier initializer() {
              bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing;
              require(
                  (isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1),
                  "Initializable: contract is already initialized"
              );
              _initialized = 1;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = true;
              }
              _;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = false;
                  emit Initialized(1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the
           * contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be
           * used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that
           * are added through upgrades and that require initialization.
           *
           * When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer`
           * cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert.
           *
           * Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in
           * a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator.
           *
           * WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) {
              require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized");
              _initialized = version;
              _initializing = true;
              _;
              _initializing = false;
              emit Initialized(version);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
           * {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly.
           */
          modifier onlyInitializing() {
              require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call.
           * Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized
           * to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called
           * through proxies.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed.
           */
          function _disableInitializers() internal virtual {
              require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing");
              if (_initialized != type(uint8).max) {
                  _initialized = type(uint8).max;
                  emit Initialized(type(uint8).max);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the highest version that has been initialized. See {reinitializer}.
           */
          function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) {
              return _initialized;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if the contract is currently initializing. See {onlyInitializing}.
           */
          function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) {
              return _initializing;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library AddressUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           *
           * Furthermore, `isContract` will also return true if the target contract within
           * the same transaction is already scheduled for destruction by `SELFDESTRUCT`,
           * which only has an effect at the end of a transaction.
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://consensys.net/diligence/blog/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.8.0/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
           * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
           *
           * _Available since v4.8._
           */
          function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
              address target,
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  if (returndata.length == 0) {
                      // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
                      // otherwise we already know that it was a contract
                      require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
                  }
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason or using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
              // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                      revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                  }
              } else {
                  revert(errorMessage);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
       * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
       * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
       * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
       * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
       * is concerned).
       *
       * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
       */
      abstract contract ContextUpgradeable is Initializable {
          function __Context_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __Context_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
              return msg.data;
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[50] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (utils/Strings.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./math/MathUpgradeable.sol";
      import "./math/SignedMathUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev String operations.
       */
      library StringsUpgradeable {
          bytes16 private constant _SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
          uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20;
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 length = MathUpgradeable.log10(value) + 1;
                  string memory buffer = new string(length);
                  uint256 ptr;
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      ptr := add(buffer, add(32, length))
                  }
                  while (true) {
                      ptr--;
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          mstore8(ptr, byte(mod(value, 10), _SYMBOLS))
                      }
                      value /= 10;
                      if (value == 0) break;
                  }
                  return buffer;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `int256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(int256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return string(abi.encodePacked(value < 0 ? "-" : "", toString(SignedMathUpgradeable.abs(value))));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  return toHexString(value, MathUpgradeable.log256(value) + 1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
              buffer[0] = "0";
              buffer[1] = "x";
              for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
                  buffer[i] = _SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
                  value >>= 4;
              }
              require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if the two strings are equal.
           */
          function equal(string memory a, string memory b) internal pure returns (bool) {
              return keccak256(bytes(a)) == keccak256(bytes(b));
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
       *
       * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
       * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
       *
       * For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
       */
      interface IERC165Upgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.9.0) (utils/math/Math.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Standard math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
       */
      library MathUpgradeable {
          enum Rounding {
              Down, // Toward negative infinity
              Up, // Toward infinity
              Zero // Toward zero
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers.
           */
          function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a > b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers.
           */
          function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the average of two numbers. The result is rounded towards
           * zero.
           */
          function average(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b) / 2 can overflow.
              return (a & b) + (a ^ b) / 2;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the ceiling of the division of two numbers.
           *
           * This differs from standard division with `/` in that it rounds up instead
           * of rounding down.
           */
          function ceilDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b - 1) / b can overflow on addition, so we distribute.
              return a == 0 ? 0 : (a - 1) / b + 1;
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates floor(x * y / denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0
           * @dev Original credit to Remco Bloemen under MIT license (https://xn--2-umb.com/21/muldiv)
           * with further edits by Uniswap Labs also under MIT license.
           */
          function mulDiv(uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator) internal pure returns (uint256 result) {
              unchecked {
                  // 512-bit multiply [prod1 prod0] = x * y. Compute the product mod 2^256 and mod 2^256 - 1, then use
                  // use the Chinese Remainder Theorem to reconstruct the 512 bit result. The result is stored in two 256
                  // variables such that product = prod1 * 2^256 + prod0.
                  uint256 prod0; // Least significant 256 bits of the product
                  uint256 prod1; // Most significant 256 bits of the product
                  assembly {
                      let mm := mulmod(x, y, not(0))
                      prod0 := mul(x, y)
                      prod1 := sub(sub(mm, prod0), lt(mm, prod0))
                  }
                  // Handle non-overflow cases, 256 by 256 division.
                  if (prod1 == 0) {
                      // Solidity will revert if denominator == 0, unlike the div opcode on its own.
                      // The surrounding unchecked block does not change this fact.
                      // See https://docs.soliditylang.org/en/latest/control-structures.html#checked-or-unchecked-arithmetic.
                      return prod0 / denominator;
                  }
                  // Make sure the result is less than 2^256. Also prevents denominator == 0.
                  require(denominator > prod1, "Math: mulDiv overflow");
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // 512 by 256 division.
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // Make division exact by subtracting the remainder from [prod1 prod0].
                  uint256 remainder;
                  assembly {
                      // Compute remainder using mulmod.
                      remainder := mulmod(x, y, denominator)
                      // Subtract 256 bit number from 512 bit number.
                      prod1 := sub(prod1, gt(remainder, prod0))
                      prod0 := sub(prod0, remainder)
                  }
                  // Factor powers of two out of denominator and compute largest power of two divisor of denominator. Always >= 1.
                  // See https://cs.stackexchange.com/q/138556/92363.
                  // Does not overflow because the denominator cannot be zero at this stage in the function.
                  uint256 twos = denominator & (~denominator + 1);
                  assembly {
                      // Divide denominator by twos.
                      denominator := div(denominator, twos)
                      // Divide [prod1 prod0] by twos.
                      prod0 := div(prod0, twos)
                      // Flip twos such that it is 2^256 / twos. If twos is zero, then it becomes one.
                      twos := add(div(sub(0, twos), twos), 1)
                  }
                  // Shift in bits from prod1 into prod0.
                  prod0 |= prod1 * twos;
                  // Invert denominator mod 2^256. Now that denominator is an odd number, it has an inverse modulo 2^256 such
                  // that denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^256. Compute the inverse by starting with a seed that is correct for
                  // four bits. That is, denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^4.
                  uint256 inverse = (3 * denominator) ^ 2;
                  // Use the Newton-Raphson iteration to improve the precision. Thanks to Hensel's lifting lemma, this also works
                  // in modular arithmetic, doubling the correct bits in each step.
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^8
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^16
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^32
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^64
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^128
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^256
                  // Because the division is now exact we can divide by multiplying with the modular inverse of denominator.
                  // This will give us the correct result modulo 2^256. Since the preconditions guarantee that the outcome is
                  // less than 2^256, this is the final result. We don't need to compute the high bits of the result and prod1
                  // is no longer required.
                  result = prod0 * inverse;
                  return result;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates x * y / denominator with full precision, following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function mulDiv(uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = mulDiv(x, y, denominator);
              if (rounding == Rounding.Up && mulmod(x, y, denominator) > 0) {
                  result += 1;
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the square root of a number. If the number is not a perfect square, the value is rounded down.
           *
           * Inspired by Henry S. Warren, Jr.'s "Hacker's Delight" (Chapter 11).
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              if (a == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              // For our first guess, we get the biggest power of 2 which is smaller than the square root of the target.
              //
              // We know that the "msb" (most significant bit) of our target number `a` is a power of 2 such that we have
              // `msb(a) <= a < 2*msb(a)`. This value can be written `msb(a)=2**k` with `k=log2(a)`.
              //
              // This can be rewritten `2**log2(a) <= a < 2**(log2(a) + 1)`
              // → `sqrt(2**k) <= sqrt(a) < sqrt(2**(k+1))`
              // → `2**(k/2) <= sqrt(a) < 2**((k+1)/2) <= 2**(k/2 + 1)`
              //
              // Consequently, `2**(log2(a) / 2)` is a good first approximation of `sqrt(a)` with at least 1 correct bit.
              uint256 result = 1 << (log2(a) >> 1);
              // At this point `result` is an estimation with one bit of precision. We know the true value is a uint128,
              // since it is the square root of a uint256. Newton's method converges quadratically (precision doubles at
              // every iteration). We thus need at most 7 iteration to turn our partial result with one bit of precision
              // into the expected uint128 result.
              unchecked {
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  return min(result, a / result);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates sqrt(a), following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = sqrt(a);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && result * result < a ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 128;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      value >>= 8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 4 > 0) {
                      value >>= 4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 2 > 0) {
                      value >>= 2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 1 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log2(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >= 10 ** 64) {
                      value /= 10 ** 64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 32) {
                      value /= 10 ** 32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 16) {
                      value /= 10 ** 16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 8) {
                      value /= 10 ** 8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 4) {
                      value /= 10 ** 4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 2) {
                      value /= 10 ** 2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 1) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log10(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 10 ** result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 256, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           *
           * Adding one to the result gives the number of pairs of hex symbols needed to represent `value` as a hex string.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 256, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log256(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << (result << 3) < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/math/SignedMath.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Standard signed math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
       */
      library SignedMathUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the largest of two signed numbers.
           */
          function max(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              return a > b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the smallest of two signed numbers.
           */
          function min(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the average of two signed numbers without overflow.
           * The result is rounded towards zero.
           */
          function average(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              // Formula from the book "Hacker's Delight"
              int256 x = (a & b) + ((a ^ b) >> 1);
              return x + (int256(uint256(x) >> 255) & (a ^ b));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the absolute unsigned value of a signed value.
           */
          function abs(int256 n) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  // must be unchecked in order to support `n = type(int256).min`
                  return uint256(n >= 0 ? n : -n);
              }
          }
      }